blob: 132a79da24dcdab855f2c1ae9796b3231099f887 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau04df1122011-04-08 00:56:41 +02007 2011/04/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100451 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - noepoll
453 - nokqueue
454 - nopoll
455 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200457 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200458 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200459 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100460 - tune.maxaccept
461 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100463 - tune.rcvbuf.client
464 - tune.rcvbuf.server
465 - tune.sndbuf.client
466 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 * Debugging
469 - debug
470 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471
472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474------------------------------------
475
476chroot <jail dir>
477 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
478 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
479 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
480 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
481 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
482 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484daemon
485 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
486 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
487 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
488
489gid <number>
490 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
491 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
492 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
493 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495group <group name>
496 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
497 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200499log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
501 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100502 configured with "log global".
503
504 <address> can be one of:
505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100506 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
508 port).
509
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100510 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100514 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
515 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
516 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
517 writeable).
518
519 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200520
521 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
522 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
523 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
524
525 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200526 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
527 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
528 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
529 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
530 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
531 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200532
533 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
534
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100535log-send-hostname [<string>]
536 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
537 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
538 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
539 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
540 the logs.
541
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000542log-tag <string>
543 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
544 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
545 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
546 running on the same host.
547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548nbproc <number>
549 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
550 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
551 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
552 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
553 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
554
555pidfile <pidfile>
556 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
557 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
558 starting the process. See also "daemon".
559
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200560stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200561 [level <level>]
562
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200563 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
564 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100565 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200566 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
567
568 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
569 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
570 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
571 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
572 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
573
574 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
575 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
576 counters).
577
578 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
579 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100580
581 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
582 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
583 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
584 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
585 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
586 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
587 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200588
589stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
590 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
591 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100592 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats maxconn <connections>
595 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
596 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
597
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598uid <number>
599 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
600 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
601 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
602 one. See also "gid" and "user".
603
604ulimit-n <number>
605 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
606 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
607 option.
608
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100609unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
610 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
611
612 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
613 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
614 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
615 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
616 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
617 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
618 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
619 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
620 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
621 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623user <user name>
624 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
625 See also "uid" and "group".
626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200627node <name>
628 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
629
630 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
631 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
632 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
633 traffic.
634
635description <text>
636 Add a text that describes the instance.
637
638 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
639 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
640 "<" and ">" characters.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644-----------------------
645
646maxconn <number>
647 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
648 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
649 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
650 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
651
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652maxpipes <number>
653 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
654 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
655 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
656 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
657 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
658 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
659
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660noepoll
661 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
662 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
663 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
664
665nokqueue
666 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
667 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
668 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
669
670nopoll
671 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
672 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100673 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
675 "nokqueue".
676
677nosepoll
678 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
679 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
680 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
681
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100682nosplice
683 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
684 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
685 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100686 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100687 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
688 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
689 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
690 "option splice-response".
691
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200692spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
693 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
694 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
695 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
696 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
697 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
698
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200699tune.bufsize <number>
700 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
701 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
702 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
703 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
704 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
705 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
706 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
707 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
708
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200709tune.chksize <number>
710 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
711 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
712 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
713 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
714 checks whenever possible.
715
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100716tune.maxaccept <number>
717 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
718 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
719 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100720 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100721 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
722 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100723 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100724 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
725
726tune.maxpollevents <number>
727 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
728 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
729 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
730 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
731 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
732
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200733tune.maxrewrite <number>
734 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
735 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
736 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
737 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
738 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
739 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
740 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
741 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
742 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
743 bufsize.
744
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100745tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
746tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
747 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
748 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
749 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
750 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
751 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
752 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
753 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
754
755tune.sndbuf.client <number>
756tune.sndbuf.server <number>
757 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
758 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
759 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
760 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
761 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
762 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
763 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
764 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
765 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
766 notifying haproxy again.
767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007693.3. Debugging
770--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771
772debug
773 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
774 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
775 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
776 system startup.
777
778quiet
779 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
780 line argument "-q".
781
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007833.4. Userlists
784--------------
785It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
786http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
787it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
788
789userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100790 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100791 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
792
793group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100794 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100795 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
796 proceeded by "users" keyword.
797
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100798user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
799 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100800 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
801 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100802 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
803 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100804 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
805 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
806
807
808 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100809 userlist L1
810 group G1 users tiger,scott
811 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100812
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100813 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
814 user scott insecure-password elgato
815 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100816
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100817 userlist L2
818 group G1
819 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100820
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100821 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
822 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
823 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824
825 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200826
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200827
8283.5. Peers
829--------------
830It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
831haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
832pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
833identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
834or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
835Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
836known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
837the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
838process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
839during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
840tables.
841
842peers <peersect>
843 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
844 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
845
846peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
847 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
848 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
849 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
850 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
851 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
852 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
853
854 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
855 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
856
857 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
858 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
859 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
860 across all peers.
861
862Example:
863 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100864 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
865 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
866 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200867
868 backend mybackend
869 mode tcp
870 balance roundrobin
871 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
872 stick on src
873
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100874 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
875 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200876
877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008784. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
882 - defaults <name>
883 - frontend <name>
884 - backend <name>
885 - listen <name>
886
887A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
888its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
889section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100890section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
892A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
893connections.
894
895A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
896to forward incoming connections.
897
898A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
899parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100901All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
902'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
903case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
904
905Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
906logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
907proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
908However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
909name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
910
911Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
912and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
915modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
916arbitrary criteria.
917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009194.1. Proxy keywords matrix
920--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
923limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
924they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
925limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100926marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200927option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200928and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
929with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
930specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100933 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
934------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
935acl - X X X
936appsession - - X X
937backlog X X X -
938balance X - X X
939bind - X X -
940bind-process X X X X
941block - X X X
942capture cookie - X X -
943capture request header - X X -
944capture response header - X X -
945clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
946contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
947cookie X - X X
948default-server X - X X
949default_backend X X X -
950description - X X X
951disabled X X X X
952dispatch - - X X
953enabled X X X X
954errorfile X X X X
955errorloc X X X X
956errorloc302 X X X X
957-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
958errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200959force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960fullconn X - X X
961grace X X X X
962hash-type X - X X
963http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100964http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200965http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966http-request - X X X
967id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200968ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100969log X X X X
970maxconn X X X -
971mode X X X X
972monitor fail - X X -
973monitor-net X X X -
974monitor-uri X X X -
975option abortonclose (*) X - X X
976option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
977option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
978option allbackups (*) X - X X
979option checkcache (*) X - X X
980option clitcpka (*) X X X -
981option contstats (*) X X X -
982option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
983option dontlognull (*) X X X -
984option forceclose (*) X X X X
985-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
986option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +0200987option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200988option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100989option http-server-close (*) X X X X
990option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
991option httpchk X - X X
992option httpclose (*) X X X X
993option httplog X X X X
994option http_proxy (*) X X X X
995option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200996option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100997option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
998option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
999option logasap (*) X X X -
1000option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001001option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001002option nolinger (*) X X X X
1003option originalto X X X X
1004option persist (*) X - X X
1005option redispatch (*) X - X X
1006option smtpchk X - X X
1007option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1008option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1009option splice-request (*) X X X X
1010option splice-response (*) X X X X
1011option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1012option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1013-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1014option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1015option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1016option tcpka X X X X
1017option tcplog X X X X
1018option transparent (*) X - X X
1019persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1020rate-limit sessions X X X -
1021redirect - X X X
1022redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1023redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1024reqadd - X X X
1025reqallow - X X X
1026reqdel - X X X
1027reqdeny - X X X
1028reqiallow - X X X
1029reqidel - X X X
1030reqideny - X X X
1031reqipass - X X X
1032reqirep - X X X
1033reqisetbe - X X X
1034reqitarpit - X X X
1035reqpass - X X X
1036reqrep - X X X
1037-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1038reqsetbe - X X X
1039reqtarpit - X X X
1040retries X - X X
1041rspadd - X X X
1042rspdel - X X X
1043rspdeny - X X X
1044rspidel - X X X
1045rspideny - X X X
1046rspirep - X X X
1047rsprep - X X X
1048server - - X X
1049source X - X X
1050srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001051stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001052stats auth X - X X
1053stats enable X - X X
1054stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001055stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001056stats realm X - X X
1057stats refresh X - X X
1058stats scope X - X X
1059stats show-desc X - X X
1060stats show-legends X - X X
1061stats show-node X - X X
1062stats uri X - X X
1063-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1064stick match - - X X
1065stick on - - X X
1066stick store-request - - X X
1067stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001068tcp-request connection - X X -
1069tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001070tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001071tcp-response content - - X X
1072tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001073timeout check X - X X
1074timeout client X X X -
1075timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1076timeout connect X - X X
1077timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1078timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1079timeout http-request X X X X
1080timeout queue X - X X
1081timeout server X - X X
1082timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1083timeout tarpit X X X X
1084transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1085use_backend - X X -
1086------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1087 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1091---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001092
1093This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1094
1095
1096acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1097 Declare or complete an access list.
1098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1099 no | yes | yes | yes
1100 Example:
1101 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1102 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1103 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001105 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001106
1107
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001108appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1109 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001110 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1112 no | no | yes | yes
1113 Arguments :
1114 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1115 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1116
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001117 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001118 checked in each cookie value.
1119
1120 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1121 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1122 milliseconds.
1123
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001124 request-learn
1125 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1126 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1127 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1128 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1129 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1130 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1131
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001132 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1133 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1134 data following this prefix.
1135
1136 Example :
1137 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1138
1139 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1140 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1141
1142 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1143 2 modes are currently supported :
1144 - path-parameters :
1145 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1146 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1147 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1148 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1149 - query-string :
1150 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1151 query string.
1152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001153 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1154 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1155 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1156 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001157 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1158 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1159 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001160 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1161 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1162
1163 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1164
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001165 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1166 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1167 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169 Example :
1170 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1171
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001172 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1173 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001174
1175
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001176backlog <conns>
1177 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1179 yes | yes | yes | no
1180 Arguments :
1181 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1182 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1183 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1184
1185 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1186 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1187 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1188 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1189 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1190 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1191 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1192 backlog parameter.
1193
1194 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1195 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1196 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1197
1198 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1199
1200
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001201balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001202balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1205 yes | no | yes | yes
1206 Arguments :
1207 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1208 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1209 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1210 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1211
1212 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1213 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1214 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1215 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001216 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1217 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1218 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1219 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1220 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1221 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1222 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1223 it, so that you don't worry.
1224
1225 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1226 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1227 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1228 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1229 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1230 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1231 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1232 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001234 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1235 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1236 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1237 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1238 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1239 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1240 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1241 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1244 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1245 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1246 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1247 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1248 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1249 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1250 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001251 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001252 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001253 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1254 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1255 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001256
1257 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1258 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1259 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1260 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1261 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1262 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1263 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001264 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1265 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1266 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001267
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001268 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1269 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1270 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1271 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1272 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1273 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1274 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1275 URIs start with a leading "/".
1276
1277 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1278 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1279 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1280 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001282 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001283 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1284
1285 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1286 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001287 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1288 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001289 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1290 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1291 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1292 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1293 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1294 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1295 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1296 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1297 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1298 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1299 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1300 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1301 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1302 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1303 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1304 be randomly balanced if at all.
1305
1306 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1307 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1308 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1309 server will receive the request.
1310
1311 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1312 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1313 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1314 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1315 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001316 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1317 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1318 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001319
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001320 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1321 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1322 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001323 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001324 algorithm is applied instead.
1325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001326 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001327 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1328 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1329 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1330
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001331 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1332 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1333 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1334
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001335 rdp-cookie
1336 rdp-cookie(name)
1337 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1338 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1339 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1340 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1341 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1342 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001343 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001344 used instead.
1345
1346 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1347 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1348 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1349 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1350
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001351 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1352 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1353 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001355 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001356 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1357 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001358
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001359 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001360 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001362 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1363 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1364 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001365
1366 Examples :
1367 balance roundrobin
1368 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001369 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001370 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1371 balance hdr(host)
1372 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001373
1374 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1375 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001377 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001378 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1379 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1380 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1381 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1382
1383 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1384 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1385 defaults to 16 kB.
1386
1387 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1388 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1389
1390 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1391 Round Robin.
1392
1393 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1394 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1395 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1396 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1397
1398 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1399
1400 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001401 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001402 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1403 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1404 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001405
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001406 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1407 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001408
1409
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001410bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1411bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1412bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1413bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1414bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1415bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1416bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001417bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001418bind /<path> [, ...]
1419bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1420bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1421bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1424 no | yes | yes | no
1425 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001426 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1427 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1428 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1429 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001430 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001431
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001432 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1433 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001434 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1435 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1436 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001437 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1438 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1439 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1440 the range.
1441
1442 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1443 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1444 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1445 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1446 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1447 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1448 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1449 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1450 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001451
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001452 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1453 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1454 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1455 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1456 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1457 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1458 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1459 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1460
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001461 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1462 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1463 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1464 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1465 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1466 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1467 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1468 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001469 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1470 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001471
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001472 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1473 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1474 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1475 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1476 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1477 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001478 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1479 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1480 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1481 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1482 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1483 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1484 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1485 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001486
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001487 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1488 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1489 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1490 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001491
1492 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1493
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001494 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1495 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1496 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1497 simply ignore this.
1498
1499 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1500 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1501 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1502 simply ignore this.
1503
1504 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1505 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1506 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1507 this.
1508
1509 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1510 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1511 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1512 this.
1513
1514 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1515 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1516 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1517 this.
1518
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001519 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1520 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1521 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001522 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001523 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1524 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1525 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1526 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001527 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1528 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001529
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001530 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001531 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1532 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1533 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1534 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1535 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1536 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1537 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1538 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1539 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1540 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1541 with front firewalls which would see an established
1542 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1543
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001544 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1545 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1546 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1547 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1548 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1549 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1550 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1551 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1552 This keyword combined with support from external components
1553 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1554 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1555 not even always usable.
1556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001557 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1558 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1559 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1560 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1561 in a frontend.
1562
1563 Example :
1564 listen http_proxy
1565 bind :80,:443
1566 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001567 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001569 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001570 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001571
1572
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001573bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1574 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1576 yes | yes | yes | yes
1577 Arguments :
1578 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1579 may be used to override a default value.
1580
1581 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1582 option may be combined with other numbers.
1583
1584 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1585 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1586 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1587 missing from all processes.
1588
1589 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1590 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1591 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1592 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1593
1594 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1595 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1596 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1597 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1598 and 'even' instances.
1599
1600 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1601 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1602 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1603 32.
1604
1605 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1606 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1607
1608 Example :
1609 listen app_ip1
1610 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001611 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001612
1613 listen app_ip2
1614 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001615 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001616
1617 listen management
1618 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001619 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001620
1621 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1622
1623
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001624block { if | unless } <condition>
1625 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1627 no | yes | yes | yes
1628
1629 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1630 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001631 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1633 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1634 "block" statements per instance.
1635
1636 Example:
1637 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1638 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1639 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1640 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001642 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643
1644
1645capture cookie <name> len <length>
1646 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1648 no | yes | yes | no
1649 Arguments :
1650 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1651 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1652 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1653 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1654 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1655
1656 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1657 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1658 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1659 right if it exceeds <length>.
1660
1661 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1662 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1663 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1664 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1665
1666 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1667 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1668 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1669
1670 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1671 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1672 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1673 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001674 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001675 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1676
1677 Example:
1678 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1679
1680 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001681 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682
1683
1684capture request header <name> len <length>
1685 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1687 no | yes | yes | no
1688 Arguments :
1689 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001690 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1692 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1693 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1694
1695 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1696 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1697 it exceeds <length>.
1698
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001699 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1701 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001702 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1703 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1704 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1705 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001706 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001707 environments to find where the request came from.
1708
1709 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1710 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1711 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1712 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001713
1714 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1715 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1716 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1717 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1718
1719 Example:
1720 capture request header Host len 15
1721 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1722 capture request header Referrer len 15
1723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001724 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001725 about logging.
1726
1727
1728capture response header <name> len <length>
1729 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1731 no | yes | yes | no
1732 Arguments :
1733 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001734 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001735 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1736 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1737 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1738
1739 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1740 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1741 it exceeds <length>.
1742
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001743 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1745 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1746 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001747 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1748 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1749 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1750 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001751
1752 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1753 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1754 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1755 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1756
1757 Example:
1758 capture response header Content-length len 9
1759 capture response header Location len 15
1760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001761 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762 about logging.
1763
1764
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001765clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001766 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1768 yes | yes | yes | no
1769 Arguments :
1770 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1771 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1772 as explained at the top of this document.
1773
1774 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1775 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1776 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1777 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1778 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1779 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1780 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1781 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001782 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1784 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1785
1786 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1787 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1788 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1789 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1790 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1791 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1792
1793 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1794 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1795
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001796 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1797 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798
1799
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001800contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1803 yes | no | yes | yes
1804 Arguments :
1805 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1806 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1807 as explained at the top of this document.
1808
1809 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001810 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001811 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001812 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1813 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1814 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1815 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1816
1817 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1818 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1819 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1820 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1821 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1822 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1823
1824 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1825 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1826 instead.
1827
1828 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1829 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1830
1831
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001832cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001833 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001834 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001835 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1837 yes | no | yes | yes
1838 Arguments :
1839 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1840 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1841 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1842 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1843 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1844 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1845 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1846 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1847 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1848
1849 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1850 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1851 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1852 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1853 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1854 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1855 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1856 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1857 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1858 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1859 "insert" and "prefix".
1860
1861 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001862 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001863
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001864 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001865 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1866 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1867 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1868 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1869 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1870 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1871 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1872 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1873 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1874 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875
1876 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1877 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1878 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1879 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1880 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1881 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1882 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1883 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1884 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1885 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1886 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1887
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001888 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1889 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1890 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001891 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1892 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1893 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1894 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
1896 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1897 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1898 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1899 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1900 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1901 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1902 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1903 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1904 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1905
1906 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1907 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1908 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1909 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1910 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1911 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1912 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1913 persistence cookie in the cache.
1914 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1915
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001916 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1917 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1918 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1919 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1920 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1921 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1922 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1923 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1924 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1925 they logout.
1926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001927 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001928 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001929 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1930 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1931 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1932 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1933 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1934 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001935
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001936 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1937 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1938 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1939 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1940 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1941 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1942 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1943 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1944 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1945 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1946 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1947 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1948 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1949 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1950 the site.
1951
1952 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1953 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1954 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1955 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1956 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1957 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1958 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1959 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1960 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1961 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1962 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1963 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1964 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1965 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1966 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1967 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1970 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1971 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1972 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974 Examples :
1975 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1976 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1977 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001978 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001979
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001980 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001981 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001984default-server [param*]
1985 Change default options for a server in a backend
1986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1987 yes | no | yes | yes
1988 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001989 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1990 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1991 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1992 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001993
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001994 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001995 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1996
1997 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000default_backend <backend>
2001 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2003 yes | yes | yes | no
2004 Arguments :
2005 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2006
2007 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2008 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2009 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2010 will catch all undetermined requests.
2011
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 Example :
2013
2014 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2015 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2016 default_backend dynamic
2017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002018 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2019
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
2021disabled
2022 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2024 yes | yes | yes | yes
2025 Arguments : none
2026
2027 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2028 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2029 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2030 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2031 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2032 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2033 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2034
2035 See also : "enabled"
2036
2037
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002038dispatch <address>:<port>
2039 Set a default server address
2040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2041 no | no | yes | yes
2042 Arguments : none
2043
2044 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2045 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2046 during start-up.
2047
2048 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2049 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2050 possible with normal servers.
2051
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002052 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002053 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2054 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2055 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2056 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2057
2058 See also : "server"
2059
2060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061enabled
2062 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2064 yes | yes | yes | yes
2065 Arguments : none
2066
2067 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2068 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2069
2070 See also : "disabled"
2071
2072
2073errorfile <code> <file>
2074 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2076 yes | yes | yes | yes
2077 Arguments :
2078 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002079 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080
2081 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002082 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002084 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2085 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
2087 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2088 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2089 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2090
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002091 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2094 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2095 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2096 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2097
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002098 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2099 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2100 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2101 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2102 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2103 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002105 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2106 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2107 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002108 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002109 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2110
2111 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2112
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002113 Example :
2114 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2115 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2116 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2117
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002118
2119errorloc <code> <url>
2120errorloc302 <code> <url>
2121 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2123 yes | yes | yes | yes
2124 Arguments :
2125 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002126 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002127
2128 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2129 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2130 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2131 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2132 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2133
2134 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2135 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2136 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2137
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002138 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2139
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002140 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2141 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2142 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2143 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2144 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2145 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2146 request.
2147
2148 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2149
2150
2151errorloc303 <code> <url>
2152 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2154 yes | yes | yes | yes
2155 Arguments :
2156 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2157 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2158
2159 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2160 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2161 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2162 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2163 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2164
2165 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2166 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2167 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2168
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002169 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2170
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002171 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2172 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2173 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2174 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002175 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002176
2177 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2178
2179
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002180force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2181 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 no | yes | yes | yes
2184
2185 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2186 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2187 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2188 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2189 marked down for maintenance operations.
2190
2191 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2192 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2193 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2194 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2195 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2196 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2197 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2198 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2199 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2200
2201 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2202 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2203 is used.
2204
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002205 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002206 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002207
2208
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002209fullconn <conns>
2210 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 yes | no | yes | yes
2213 Arguments :
2214 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2215 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2216
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002217 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002218 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002219 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002220 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2221 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2222 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2223 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2224 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002225 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002226
2227 Example :
2228 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2229 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2230 # connections.
2231 backend dynamic
2232 fullconn 10000
2233 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2234 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2235
2236 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2237
2238
2239grace <time>
2240 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002242 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002243 Arguments :
2244 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2245 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2246 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2247
2248 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2249 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002250 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002251 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2252
2253 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2254 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2255 simplify it.
2256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002257
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002258hash-type <method>
2259 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2261 yes | no | yes | yes
2262 Arguments :
2263 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2264 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2265 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2266 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2267 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2268 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2269 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2270 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2271 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2272
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002273 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2274 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2275 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2276 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2277 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2278 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2279 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2280 this value.
2281
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002282 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2283 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2284 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2285 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2286 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2287 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2288 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2289 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2290 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2291 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2292 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2293 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2294 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2295
2296 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2297
2298 See also : "balance", "server"
2299
2300
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002301http-check disable-on-404
2302 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002304 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305 Arguments : none
2306
2307 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2308 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2309 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2310 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2311 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2312 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2313 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2314 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002315 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2316 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2317 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2318
2319 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2320
2321
2322http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2323 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2325 no | no | yes | yes
2326 Arguments :
2327 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2328 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2329 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2330 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2331 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2332 details on the supported keywords.
2333
2334 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2335 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2336 with the usual backslash ('\').
2337
2338 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2339 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2340 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2341 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2342 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2343
2344 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2345 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2346 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2347 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2348 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2349
2350 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2351 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2352 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2353 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2354 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2355 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2356
2357 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2358 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2359 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2360 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2361 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2362 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2363 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2364 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2365 trace).
2366
2367 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2368 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2369 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2370 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2371 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2372 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2373 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2374 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2375
2376 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2377 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2378 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2379 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2380 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2381 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2382 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2383 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2384
2385 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2386 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2387
2388 Examples :
2389 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002390 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002391
2392 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002393 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002394
2395 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002396 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002397
2398 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002399 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002401 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002402
2403
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002404http-check send-state
2405 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2407 yes | no | yes | yes
2408 Arguments : none
2409
2410 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2411 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2412 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2413 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2414 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2415
2416 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2417 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2418 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2419 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2420 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2421 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2422 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2423 checked in multiple backends.
2424
2425 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2426 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2427
2428 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2429 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2430 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2431 one fails.
2432
2433 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2434 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2435 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2436
2437 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2438 server's queue.
2439
2440 Example of a header received by the application server :
2441 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2442 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2443
2444 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2445
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002446http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002448 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2449
2450 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 no | yes | yes | yes
2452
2453 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2454 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2455 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002456 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2457 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002458 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2459
2460 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2461 instance.
2462
2463 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002464 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2465 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2466 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002467
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002468 http-request allow if nagios
2469 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2470 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2471 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002472
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002473 Example:
2474 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002475
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002476 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002477
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002478 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2479 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002481id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002482 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 no | yes | yes | yes
2485 Arguments : none
2486
2487 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2488 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2489 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002490
2491
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002492ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2493 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2495 no | yes | yes | yes
2496
2497 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2498 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2499 and running).
2500
2501 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2502 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2503 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2504 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2505 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2506
2507 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2508 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2509
2510 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2511 "unless" condition is met.
2512
2513 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2514
2515
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002516log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002517log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002518 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2520 yes | yes | yes | yes
2521 Arguments :
2522 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2523 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2524 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2525 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2526 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2527 parameter.
2528
2529 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2530 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2531
2532 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2533 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2534 standard syslog port).
2535
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002536 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2537 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2538 standard syslog port).
2539
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002540 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2541 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2542 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2543 appropriately writeable).
2544
2545 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2546
2547 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2548 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2549 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2550
2551 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2552 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2553 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002554 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2555 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2556 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2557 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2558 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002559
2560 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2561
2562 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2563 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2564 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2565
2566 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002567 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2568 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2569 "info".
2570
2571 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2572 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2573 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2574 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2575
2576 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2577 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002578
2579 Example :
2580 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002581 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2582 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002583
2584
2585maxconn <conns>
2586 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2588 yes | yes | yes | no
2589 Arguments :
2590 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2591 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2592 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2593 closes.
2594
2595 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2596 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2597 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2598 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2599 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2600 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2601 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2602 properly tuned.
2603
2604 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2605 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2606 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2607
2608 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2609
2610
2611mode { tcp|http|health }
2612 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2614 yes | yes | yes | yes
2615 Arguments :
2616 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2617 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2618 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2619 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2620
2621 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2622 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2623 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2624 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2625 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2626
2627 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2628 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2629 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2630 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2631 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2632 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2633
2634 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2635 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2636 will be refused.
2637
2638 Example :
2639 defaults http_instances
2640 mode http
2641
2642 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2643
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002644
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002645monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2648 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002649 Arguments :
2650 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2651 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002652 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002653 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2654 backend and its backup.
2655
2656 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2657 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2658 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2659 servers in a list of backends.
2660
2661 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2662 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2663 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2664 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2665 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2666 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2667 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002668 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2669 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670
2671 Example:
2672 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002673 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2675 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2676 monitor-uri /site_alive
2677 monitor fail if site_dead
2678
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002679 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002680
2681
2682monitor-net <source>
2683 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 yes | yes | yes | no
2686 Arguments :
2687 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2688 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2689 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2690 followed by a mask.
2691
2692 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2693 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002694 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002695 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2696
2697 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2698 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2699 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2700 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2701 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2702
2703 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2704 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2705 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2706 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2707 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2708
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002709 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2710 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002712 Example :
2713 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2714 frontend www
2715 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2716
2717 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2718
2719
2720monitor-uri <uri>
2721 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2723 yes | yes | yes | no
2724 Arguments :
2725 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2726 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2727
2728 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2729 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2730 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2731 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2732 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2733 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2734 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2735 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2736
2737 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2738 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2739 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2740 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2741 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2742 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2743
2744 Example :
2745 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2746 frontend www
2747 mode http
2748 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2749
2750 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002752
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002753option abortonclose
2754no option abortonclose
2755 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2757 yes | no | yes | yes
2758 Arguments : none
2759
2760 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2761 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2762 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2763 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002764 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002765 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2766 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2767 encountered while delivering the response.
2768
2769 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2770 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2771 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2772 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2773 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2774 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002775 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002776 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002777 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002778 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2779 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2780 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2781
2782 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2783 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2784 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2785 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2786 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2787 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2788 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2789 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002790 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002791
2792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2794
2795 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2796
2797
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002798option accept-invalid-http-request
2799no option accept-invalid-http-request
2800 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2802 yes | yes | yes | no
2803 Arguments : none
2804
2805 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2806 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2807 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2808 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2809 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2810 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2811 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2812 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2813 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2814
2815 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2816 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2817 been confirmed.
2818
2819 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2820 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2821 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2822 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2823
2824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2826
2827 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2828 stats socket.
2829
2830
2831option accept-invalid-http-response
2832no option accept-invalid-http-response
2833 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2835 yes | no | yes | yes
2836 Arguments : none
2837
2838 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2839 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2840 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2841 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2842 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2843 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2844 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2845 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2846 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2847
2848 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2849 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2850 been confirmed.
2851
2852 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2853 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2854 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2855 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2856
2857 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2858 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2859
2860 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2861 stats socket.
2862
2863
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002864option allbackups
2865no option allbackups
2866 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2868 yes | no | yes | yes
2869 Arguments : none
2870
2871 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2872 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2873 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2874 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2875 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2876 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2877 order between the backup servers anymore.
2878
2879 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2880 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2881
2882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2884
2885
2886option checkcache
2887no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002888 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2890 yes | no | yes | yes
2891 Arguments : none
2892
2893 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2894 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002895 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002896 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2897 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2898 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2899
2900 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002901 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002902 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002903 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2904 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002905 to the client are :
2906 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002907 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002908 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002909 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2910 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2911 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2912 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2913 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2914 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2915 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2916 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2917 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2918 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2919 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2920
2921 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002922 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002923 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002924 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002925 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2926
2927 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2928 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002929 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002930 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2931
2932 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2933 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2934
2935
2936option clitcpka
2937no option clitcpka
2938 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2940 yes | yes | yes | no
2941 Arguments : none
2942
2943 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2944 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2945 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2946 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2947
2948 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2949 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2950 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2951 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2952
2953 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2954 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2955 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2956 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2957 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2958
2959 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2960
2961 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2962 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2963 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2964
2965 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2966 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2967
2968 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2969
2970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971option contstats
2972 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2974 yes | yes | yes | no
2975 Arguments : none
2976
2977 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2978 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2979 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2980 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2981 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2982 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2983 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2984
2985
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002986option dontlog-normal
2987no option dontlog-normal
2988 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 yes | yes | yes | no
2991 Arguments : none
2992
2993 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2994 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2995 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2996 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2997 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2998 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2999 logged.
3000
3001 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3002 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3003 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003005 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003006 logging.
3007
3008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003009option dontlognull
3010no option dontlognull
3011 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3013 yes | yes | yes | no
3014 Arguments : none
3015
3016 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3017 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3018 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3019 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3020 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3021 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3022 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3023
3024 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3025 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3026 would not be logged.
3027
3028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003031 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003032
3033
3034option forceclose
3035no option forceclose
3036 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003038 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003039 Arguments : none
3040
3041 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3042 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3043 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3044 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3045 global session times in the logs.
3046
3047 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003048 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003049 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3050 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3051 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3052 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003053
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003054 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3055 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3056 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3057
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3060
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003061 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003062
3063
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003064option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003065 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3067 yes | yes | yes | yes
3068 Arguments :
3069 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3070 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003071 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003072 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003073
3074 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3075 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3076 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3077 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3078 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3079 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3080 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003081 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3082 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3083 possible that the client has already brought one.
3084
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003085 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003086 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003087 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3088 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003089 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3090 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003091
3092 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3093 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3094 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3095 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3096 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3097 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3098 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3099
3100 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003101 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3102 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3103 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003104
3105 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3106 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3107 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3108 when using this option.
3109
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003110 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003111 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3112 frontend www
3113 mode http
3114 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3115
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003116 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3117 backend www
3118 mode http
3119 option forwardfor header X-Client
3120
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003121 See also : "option httpclose"
3122
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003123
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003124option http-no-delay
3125no option http-no-delay
3126 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 yes | yes | yes | yes
3129 Arguments : none
3130
3131 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3132 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3133 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3134 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3135 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3136 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3137 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3138 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3139 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3140 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3141 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3142 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3143 affected.
3144
3145 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3146 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3147 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3148 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3149 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3150 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3151 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3152 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3153 latency environments.
3154
3155
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003156option http-pretend-keepalive
3157no option http-pretend-keepalive
3158 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3160 yes | yes | yes | yes
3161 Arguments : none
3162
3163 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3164 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3165 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3166 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3167 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3168 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3169 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3170 consider the response complete.
3171
3172 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3173 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3174 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3175 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3176 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3177 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3178
3179 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3180 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3181 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3182 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3183 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3184 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3185 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3186
3187 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3188 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003189 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3190 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3191 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003192
3193 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3194 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3195
3196 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3197
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003198
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003199option http-server-close
3200no option http-server-close
3201 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3203 yes | yes | yes | yes
3204 Arguments : none
3205
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003206 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3207 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3208 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3209 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3210 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3211 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3212 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3213 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3214 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3215 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3216 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3217 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003218
3219 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3220 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3221 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3222 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003223 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3224 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003225
3226 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3227 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003228 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3229 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3230 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003231
3232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3234
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003235 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3236 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003237
3238
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003239option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003240no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003241 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | no
3244 Arguments : none
3245
3246 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3247 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3248 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3249 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3250 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3251 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3252 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3253
3254 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3255 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3256 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3257 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3258 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3259 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3260 request along its whole life.
3261
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003262 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3263 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3264 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3265 front of an existing proxy.
3266
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003267 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3268
3269 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3270 http-server-close".
3271
3272
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003273option httpchk
3274option httpchk <uri>
3275option httpchk <method> <uri>
3276option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3277 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3279 yes | no | yes | yes
3280 Arguments :
3281 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3282 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3283 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3284 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3285 ones.
3286
3287 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3288 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3289 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3290
3291 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3292 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3293 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3294 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3295 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3296
3297 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3298 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3299 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3300 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3301 the lack of any response.
3302
3303 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3304
3305 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3306 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3307 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3308
3309 Examples :
3310 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3311 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3312 backend https_relay
3313 mode tcp
3314 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3315 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3316
3317 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003318 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3319 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003320
3321
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003322option httpclose
3323no option httpclose
3324 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3326 yes | yes | yes | yes
3327 Arguments : none
3328
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003329 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3330 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3331 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3332 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3333 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3334 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3335 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003336
3337 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003338 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3339 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3340 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3341 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3342 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3343 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003344
3345 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3346 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3347 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003348 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3349 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003350
3351 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3352 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3353
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003354 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3355 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003356
3357
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003358option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003359 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3361 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003362 Arguments :
3363 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3364 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3365 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3366 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3367 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003368
3369 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3370 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3371 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3372 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3373 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3374 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3375 ports.
3376
3377 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3378
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3381 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3382 by default.
3383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003384 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003385
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003386
3387option http_proxy
3388no option http_proxy
3389 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 yes | yes | yes | yes
3392 Arguments : none
3393
3394 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3395 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3396 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3397 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3398 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3399
3400 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3401 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3402 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3403 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003404 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003405 be analyzed.
3406
3407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3409
3410 Example :
3411 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3412 backend direct_forward
3413 option httpclose
3414 option http_proxy
3415
3416 See also : "option httpclose"
3417
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003418
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003419option independant-streams
3420no option independant-streams
3421 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3423 yes | yes | yes | yes
3424 Arguments : none
3425
3426 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3427 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3428 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3429 receive data or not.
3430
3431 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3432 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3433 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3434 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3435 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3436 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3437 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3438 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3439 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3440 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3441 socket buffers.
3442
3443 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3444 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3445 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3446 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3447 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3448
3449 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3450
3451
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003452option ldap-check
3453 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3455 yes | no | yes | yes
3456 Arguments : none
3457
3458 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3459 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3460 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3461 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3462
3463 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3464 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3465
3466 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3467 configure it.
3468
3469 Example :
3470 option ldap-check
3471
3472 See also : "option httpchk"
3473
3474
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003475option log-health-checks
3476no option log-health-checks
3477 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3479 yes | no | yes | yes
3480 Arguments : none
3481
3482 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3483 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3484 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3485 of additional information is limited.
3486
3487 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3488 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3489
3490 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3491
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003492
3493option log-separate-errors
3494no option log-separate-errors
3495 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3497 yes | yes | yes | no
3498 Arguments : none
3499
3500 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3501 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3502 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3503 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3504 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3505 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3506 provides very important information.
3507
3508 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3509 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3510 error logs.
3511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003512 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003513 logging.
3514
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003515
3516option logasap
3517no option logasap
3518 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3520 yes | yes | yes | no
3521 Arguments : none
3522
3523 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3524 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3525 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3526 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3527 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3528 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3529 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003530 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003531 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3532 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3533
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003534 Examples :
3535 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3536 mode http
3537 option httplog
3538 option logasap
3539 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3540
3541 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3542 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3543 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3544 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003546 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003547 logging.
3548
3549
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003550option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3551 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3553 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003554 Arguments :
3555 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3556 to MySQL server.
3557
3558 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3559 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3560 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3561 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3562 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3563 in the MySQL table, like this :
3564
3565 USE mysql;
3566 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3567 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3568
3569 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3570 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3571 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3572 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3573 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3574 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3575 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3576 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3577 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3578
3579 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3580 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003581
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003582 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003583
3584 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3585 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3586 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3587 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3588 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3589 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3590
3591 See also: "option httpchk"
3592
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003593option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3594 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3596 yes | no | yes | yes
3597 Arguments :
3598 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3599 to PostgreSQL server.
3600
3601 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3602 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3603 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3604 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3605
3606 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003607
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003608option nolinger
3609no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003610 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3612 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003613 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003614
3615 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3616 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3617 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3618 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3619 connections.
3620
3621 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3622 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3623 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3624 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3625 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3626 this too.
3627
3628 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3629 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3630 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3631
3632 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3633 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3634 for servers.
3635
3636 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3637 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3638
3639
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003640option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3641 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3643 yes | yes | yes | yes
3644 Arguments :
3645 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3646 matching <network>
3647 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3648 header name.
3649
3650 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3651 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3652 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3653 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3654 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3655 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3656 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3657 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3658 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3659 possible that the client has already brought one.
3660
3661 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3662 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3663 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3664 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3665 header and requires different one.
3666
3667 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3668 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3669 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3670 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3671 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3672 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3673 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3674
3675 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3676 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3677 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3678 both are defined.
3679
3680 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3681 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3682 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3683 when using this option.
3684
3685 Examples :
3686 # Original Destination address
3687 frontend www
3688 mode http
3689 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3690
3691 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3692 backend www
3693 mode http
3694 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3695
3696 See also : "option httpclose"
3697
3698
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003699option persist
3700no option persist
3701 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3702 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3703 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003704 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003705
3706 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3707 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3708 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3709 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3710 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3711 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3712 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3713 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3714 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3715 redirected to another valid server.
3716
3717 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3718 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3719
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003720 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003721
3722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003723option redispatch
3724no option redispatch
3725 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003728 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003729
3730 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3731 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3732 be able to access the service anymore.
3733
3734 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3735 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3736
3737 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3738 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3739 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003741 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3742 "redisp" keywords.
3743
3744 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3745 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3746
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003747 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003748
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003749
3750option smtpchk
3751option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3752 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3754 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003755 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003756 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3757 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3758 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3759
3760 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3761 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3762 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3763
3764 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3765 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3766 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3767 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3768 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3769 dead server.
3770
3771 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3772 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3773 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3774 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3775
3776 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3777 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3778 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3779 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3780 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3781
3782 Example :
3783 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3784
3785 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003788option socket-stats
3789no option socket-stats
3790
3791 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3793 yes | yes | yes | no
3794
3795 Arguments : none
3796
3797
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003798option splice-auto
3799no option splice-auto
3800 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3802 yes | yes | yes | yes
3803 Arguments : none
3804
3805 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3806 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3807 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3808 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003809 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003810 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3811 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3812 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3813 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3814
3815 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3816 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3817 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3818 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3819 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3820 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3821 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3822 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3823 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3824 keyword.
3825
3826 Example :
3827 option splice-auto
3828
3829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3831
3832 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3833 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3834
3835
3836option splice-request
3837no option splice-request
3838 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3840 yes | yes | yes | yes
3841 Arguments : none
3842
3843 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3844 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3845 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3846 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3847 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3848 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3849
3850 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3851
3852 Example :
3853 option splice-request
3854
3855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3857
3858 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3859 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3860
3861
3862option splice-response
3863no option splice-response
3864 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3866 yes | yes | yes | yes
3867 Arguments : none
3868
3869 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3870 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3871 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3872 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3873 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3874 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3875
3876 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3877
3878 Example :
3879 option splice-response
3880
3881 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3882 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3883
3884 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3885 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3886
3887
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003888option srvtcpka
3889no option srvtcpka
3890 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3892 yes | no | yes | yes
3893 Arguments : none
3894
3895 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3896 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3897 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3898 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3899
3900 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3901 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3902 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3903 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3904
3905 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3906 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3907 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3908 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3909 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3910
3911 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3912
3913 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3914 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3915 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3916
3917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3919
3920 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3921
3922
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003923option ssl-hello-chk
3924 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3926 yes | no | yes | yes
3927 Arguments : none
3928
3929 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3930 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3931 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3932 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3933 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3934 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3935 hello message.
3936
3937 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3938 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3939 messages, which is appreciable.
3940
3941 See also: "option httpchk"
3942
3943
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003944option tcp-smart-accept
3945no option tcp-smart-accept
3946 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3948 yes | yes | yes | no
3949 Arguments : none
3950
3951 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3952 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3953 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3954 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3955 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3956 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3957
3958 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3959 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3960 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3961 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3962
3963 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3964 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3965 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3966 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3967
3968 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3969 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3970 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3971
3972 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3973 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3974 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3975
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003976 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3977
3978
3979option tcp-smart-connect
3980no option tcp-smart-connect
3981 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 yes | no | yes | yes
3984 Arguments : none
3985
3986 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3987 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3988 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3989 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3990 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3991
3992 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3993 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3994 complex.
3995
3996 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3997 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3998 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3999
4000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4002
4003 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4004
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004005
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004006option tcpka
4007 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4009 yes | yes | yes | yes
4010 Arguments : none
4011
4012 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4013 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4014 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4015 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4016
4017 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4018 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4019 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4020 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4021
4022 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4023 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4024 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4025 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4026 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4027
4028 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4029
4030 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4031 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4032 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4033 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4034 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4035 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4036 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4037 backends.
4038
4039 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4040
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004041
4042option tcplog
4043 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | yes | yes | yes
4046 Arguments : none
4047
4048 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4049 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4050 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4051 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4052 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4053 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4054 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4055 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4056
4057 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004059 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004060
4061
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004062option transparent
4063no option transparent
4064 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004066 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004067 Arguments : none
4068
4069 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4070 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4071 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4072 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4073 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4074 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4075 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4076 appropriate server.
4077
4078 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4079 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4080
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004081 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004082 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004083
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004084
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004085persist rdp-cookie
4086persist rdp-cookie(name)
4087 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4089 yes | no | yes | yes
4090 Arguments :
4091 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004092 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4093 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004094
4095 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4096 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4097 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4098 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4099 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4100 forwarded to this server.
4101
4102 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4103 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4104 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004105 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004106 a single "listen" section.
4107
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004108 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4109 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4110 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4111
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004112 Example :
4113 listen tse-farm
4114 bind :3389
4115 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4116 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4117 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4118 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4119 persist rdp-cookie
4120 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4121 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4122 balance rdp-cookie
4123 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4124 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4125
4126 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4127
4128
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004129rate-limit sessions <rate>
4130 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 yes | yes | yes | no
4133 Arguments :
4134 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4135 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4136
4137 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4138 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4139 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4140 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4141 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4142 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4143
4144 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4145 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4146 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4147 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4148
4149 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4150 listen smtp
4151 mode tcp
4152 bind :25
4153 rate-limit sessions 10
4154 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4155
4156 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4157 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4158
4159 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4160
4161
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004162redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4163redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004164 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4166 no | yes | yes | yes
4167
4168 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004169 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004170
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004171 Arguments :
4172 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4173 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4174 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4175 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004176 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4177 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4178 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4179 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004180
4181 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4182 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4183 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4184 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4185 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4186 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4187 location with a GET method.
4188
4189 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4190 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4191
4192 - "drop-query"
4193 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4194 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4195 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4196 with a location-type redirect.
4197
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004198 - "append-slash"
4199 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4200 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4201 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4202 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4203
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004204 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4205 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4206 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4207 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4208 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4209 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4210 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4211
4212 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4213 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4214 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4215 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4216 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4217 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4218 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004219
4220 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4221 acl clear dst_port 80
4222 acl secure dst_port 8080
4223 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004224 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004225 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004226 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4227
4228 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004229 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4230 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4231 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004232 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004233
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004234 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4235 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4236 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004238 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004239
4240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004241redisp (deprecated)
4242redispatch (deprecated)
4243 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4244 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4245 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004246 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004247
4248 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4249 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4250 be able to access the service anymore.
4251
4252 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4253 redistribute them to a working server.
4254
4255 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4256 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4257 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004259 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4260 "option redispatch" instead.
4261
4262 See also : "option redispatch"
4263
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004264
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004265reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004266 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 no | yes | yes | yes
4269 Arguments :
4270 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4271 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004272 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004273
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004274 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4275 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4276
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004277 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4278 the last header of an HTTP request.
4279
4280 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4281 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4282 responses.
4283
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004284 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4285 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4286 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4287
4288 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4289 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004290
4291
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004292reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4293reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004294 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4296 no | yes | yes | yes
4297 Arguments :
4298 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4299 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4300 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4301 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4302 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4303 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4304 ignores case.
4305
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004306 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4307 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4308
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004309 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4310 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4311 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4312 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004313 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004314
4315 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4316 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4317
4318 Example :
4319 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4320 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4321 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4322
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004323 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4324 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004325
4326
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004327reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4328reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004329 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4331 no | yes | yes | yes
4332 Arguments :
4333 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4334 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4335 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4336 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4337 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4338 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4339
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004340 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4341 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4342
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004343 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4344 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4345 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4346 next servers.
4347
4348 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4349 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4350 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4351
4352 Example :
4353 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4354 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4355 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4356
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004357 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4358 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004359
4360
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004361reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4362reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004363 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4365 no | yes | yes | yes
4366 Arguments :
4367 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4368 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4369 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4370 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4371 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4372 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4373 case.
4374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004375 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4376 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4377
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004378 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4379 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4380 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4381 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004382 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004383
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004384 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004385 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004386 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004387
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004388 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4389 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4390
4391 Example :
4392 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4393 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4394 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4395
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004396 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4397 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004398
4399
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004400reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4401reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004402 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 no | yes | yes | yes
4405 Arguments :
4406 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4407 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4408 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4409 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4410 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4411 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4412 case.
4413
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004414 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4415 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4416
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004417 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4418 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4419 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4420 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4421
4422 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4423 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4424
4425 Example :
4426 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4427 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4428 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4429 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4430
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004431 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4432 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004433
4434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004435reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4436reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004437 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4439 no | yes | yes | yes
4440 Arguments :
4441 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4442 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4443 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4444 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4445 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4446 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4447
4448 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4449 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4450 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4451 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004452 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004453
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004454 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4455 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4456
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004457 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4458 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4459 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4460
4461 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4462 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4463 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4464 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4465 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4466
4467 Example :
4468 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4469 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4470 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4471 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4472
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004473 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4474 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004475
4476
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004477reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4478reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004479 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 no | yes | yes | yes
4482 Arguments :
4483 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4484 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4485 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4486 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4487 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4488 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4489 ignores case.
4490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004491 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4492 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4493
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004494 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4495 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004496 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4497 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4498 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004499 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4500 not set.
4501
4502 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4503 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4504 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4505 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4506 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4507
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004508 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004509 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4510 # block all others.
4511 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4512 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4513
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004514 # block bad guys
4515 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4516 reqitarpit . if badguys
4517
4518 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4519 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004520
4521
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004522retries <value>
4523 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4525 yes | no | yes | yes
4526 Arguments :
4527 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4528 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4529 default value is 3.
4530
4531 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4532 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4533 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4534
4535 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4536 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4537
4538 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4539 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4540
4541 See also : "option redispatch"
4542
4543
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004544rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004545 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4547 no | yes | yes | yes
4548 Arguments :
4549 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4550 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004551 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004553 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4554 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4555
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004556 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4557 the last header of an HTTP response.
4558
4559 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4560 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4561 responses.
4562
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004563 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4564 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004565
4566
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004567rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4568rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004569 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4571 no | yes | yes | yes
4572 Arguments :
4573 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4574 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4575 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4576 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4577 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4578 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4579 ignores case.
4580
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004581 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4582 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4583
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004584 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4585 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4586 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4587 client.
4588
4589 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4590 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4591 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4592
4593 Example :
4594 # remove the Server header from responses
4595 reqidel ^Server:.*
4596
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004597 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4598 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004599
4600
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004601rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4602rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004603 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4605 no | yes | yes | yes
4606 Arguments :
4607 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4608 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4609 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4610 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4611 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4612 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4613 ignores case.
4614
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004615 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4616 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4617
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004618 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4619 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4620 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4621 case-sensitive.
4622
4623 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004624 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4625 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4626 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004627
4628 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4629 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4630
4631 Example :
4632 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4633 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4634
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004635 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4636 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004637
4638
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004639rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4640rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004641 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4643 no | yes | yes | yes
4644 Arguments :
4645 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4646 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4647 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4648 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4649 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4650 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4651 ignores case.
4652
4653 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4654 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4655 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4656 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004657 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004658
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004659 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4660 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4661
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004662 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4663 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4664 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4665
4666 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4667 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4668 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4669 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4670 are not case-sensitive.
4671
4672 Example :
4673 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4674 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4675
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004676 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4677 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004678
4679
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004680server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004681 Declare a server in a backend
4682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4683 no | no | yes | yes
4684 Arguments :
4685 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4686 appear in logs and alerts.
4687
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004688 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4689 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4690 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4691 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004692 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4693 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4694 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4695 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4696 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4697 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004698
4699 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4700 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4701 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4702 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4703 adding this value to the client's port.
4704
4705 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4706 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004707 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004708
4709 Examples :
4710 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4711 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004713 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004714
4715
4716source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004717source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004718source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004719 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4721 yes | no | yes | yes
4722 Arguments :
4723 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4724 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4725 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4726 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4727
4728 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4729 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004730 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4731 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4732 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004733
4734 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4735 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4736 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4737 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4738 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4739 <addr>.
4740
4741 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4742 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4743 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4744 port.
4745
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004746 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4747 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4748 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4749 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4750 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4751 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4752 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4753 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4754 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4755 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4756 HTTP header.
4757
4758 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4759 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4760 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4761 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4762 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4763 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4764 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4765 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4766 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4767 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4768
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004769 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4770 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4771 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4772 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4773 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4774 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4775
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004776 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4777 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4778 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4779 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4780
4781 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4782 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4783 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4784 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4785 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4786 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4787
4788 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4789 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4790 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4791 there are two methods :
4792
4793 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4794 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4795 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4796 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4797 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4798 of the client ranges may be used.
4799
4800 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4801 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4802 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4803 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4804 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4805 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4806 same session.
4807
4808 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4809 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4810 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4811 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4812 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4813 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4814
4815 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4816 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4817 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004818 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004819
4820 Examples :
4821 backend private
4822 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4823 source 192.168.1.200
4824
4825 backend transparent_ssl1
4826 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4827 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4828
4829 backend transparent_ssl2
4830 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4831 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4832 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4833
4834 backend transparent_ssl3
4835 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4836 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4837 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4838
4839 backend transparent_smtp
4840 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4841 # with Tproxy version 4.
4842 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4843
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004844 backend transparent_http
4845 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4846 # proxy.
4847 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004849 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004850 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004852
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004853srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4854 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4856 yes | no | yes | yes
4857 Arguments :
4858 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4860 as explained at the top of this document.
4861
4862 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4863 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4864 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4865 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4866 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4867 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4868 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4869
4870 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4871 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4872 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4873 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4874 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004875 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004876 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004877 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004878
4879 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4880 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4881 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4882 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4883 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4884 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4885
4886 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4887 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4888
4889 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4890
4891
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004892stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4893 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4895 no | no | yes | yes
4896
4897 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4898 matched.
4899
4900 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4901 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4902
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004903 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4904 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4905 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4906
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004907 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4908 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4909 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4910 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004911
4912 Example :
4913 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4914 backend stats_localhost
4915 stats enable
4916 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4917
4918 Example :
4919 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4920 backend stats_auth
4921 stats enable
4922 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4923 stats admin if TRUE
4924
4925 Example :
4926 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4927 userlist stats-auth
4928 group admin users admin
4929 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4930 group readonly users haproxy
4931 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4932
4933 backend stats_auth
4934 stats enable
4935 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4936 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4937 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4938 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4939
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004940 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
4941 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4942 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004943
4944
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004945stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4946 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4948 yes | no | yes | yes
4949 Arguments :
4950 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4951
4952 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4953
4954 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4955 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4956 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4957 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4958 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4959 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4960
4961 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4962 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4963 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4964 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4965
4966 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4967 report using "stats scope".
4968
4969 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4970 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4971 unobvious parameters.
4972
4973 Example :
4974 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4975 backend public_www
4976 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4977 stats enable
4978 stats hide-version
4979 stats scope .
4980 stats uri /admin?stats
4981 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4982 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4983 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4984
4985 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4986 backend private_monitoring
4987 stats enable
4988 stats uri /admin?stats
4989 stats refresh 5s
4990
4991 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4992
4993
4994stats enable
4995 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 yes | no | yes | yes
4998 Arguments : none
4999
5000 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5001 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5002 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5003 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5004 - stats auth : no authentication
5005 - stats scope : no restriction
5006
5007 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5008 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5009 unobvious parameters.
5010
5011 Example :
5012 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5013 backend public_www
5014 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5015 stats enable
5016 stats hide-version
5017 stats scope .
5018 stats uri /admin?stats
5019 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5020 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5021 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5022
5023 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5024 backend private_monitoring
5025 stats enable
5026 stats uri /admin?stats
5027 stats refresh 5s
5028
5029 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5030
5031
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005032stats hide-version
5033 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5035 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005036 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005037
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005038 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5039 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5040 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5041 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5042 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5043 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005045 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5046 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5047 unobvious parameters.
5048
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005049 Example :
5050 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5051 backend public_www
5052 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005053 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005054 stats hide-version
5055 stats scope .
5056 stats uri /admin?stats
5057 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5058 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5059 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005060
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005061 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5062 backend private_monitoring
5063 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005064 stats uri /admin?stats
5065 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005066
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005067 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005068
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005069
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005070stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5071 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5072 Access control for statistics
5073
5074 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 no | no | yes | yes
5076
5077 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5078 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5079 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5080 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5081 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5082 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5083
5084 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5085 instance.
5086
5087 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5088 about ACL usage.
5089
5090
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005091stats realm <realm>
5092 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | no | yes | yes
5095 Arguments :
5096 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5097 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5098 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5099
5100 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5101 using a backslash ('\').
5102
5103 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5104 only related to authentication.
5105
5106 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5107 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5108 unobvious parameters.
5109
5110 Example :
5111 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5112 backend public_www
5113 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5114 stats enable
5115 stats hide-version
5116 stats scope .
5117 stats uri /admin?stats
5118 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5119 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5120 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5121
5122 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5123 backend private_monitoring
5124 stats enable
5125 stats uri /admin?stats
5126 stats refresh 5s
5127
5128 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5129
5130
5131stats refresh <delay>
5132 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5134 yes | no | yes | yes
5135 Arguments :
5136 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5137 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5138 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5139 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5140 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5141 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5142
5143 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5144 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5145 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5146 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5147
5148 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5149 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5150 unobvious parameters.
5151
5152 Example :
5153 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5154 backend public_www
5155 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5156 stats enable
5157 stats hide-version
5158 stats scope .
5159 stats uri /admin?stats
5160 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5161 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5162 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5163
5164 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5165 backend private_monitoring
5166 stats enable
5167 stats uri /admin?stats
5168 stats refresh 5s
5169
5170 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5171
5172
5173stats scope { <name> | "." }
5174 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 yes | no | yes | yes
5177 Arguments :
5178 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5179 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5180 section in which the statement appears.
5181
5182 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5183 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5184 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5185 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5186 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5187 exists.
5188
5189 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5190 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5191 unobvious parameters.
5192
5193 Example :
5194 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5195 backend public_www
5196 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5197 stats enable
5198 stats hide-version
5199 stats scope .
5200 stats uri /admin?stats
5201 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5202 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5203 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5204
5205 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5206 backend private_monitoring
5207 stats enable
5208 stats uri /admin?stats
5209 stats refresh 5s
5210
5211 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5212
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005213
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005214stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005215 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5217 yes | no | yes | yes
5218
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005219 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005220 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5221
5222 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5223 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5224
5225 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5226 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5227 unobvious parameters.
5228
5229 Example :
5230 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5231 backend private_monitoring
5232 stats enable
5233 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5234 stats uri /admin?stats
5235 stats refresh 5s
5236
5237 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5238 global section.
5239
5240
5241stats show-legends
5242 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5243 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5244 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5245 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5246 - IP (socket, server)
5247 - cookie (backend, server)
5248
5249 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5250 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5251 unobvious parameters.
5252
5253 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5254
5255
5256stats show-node [ <name> ]
5257 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5259 yes | no | yes | yes
5260 Arguments:
5261 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5262 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5263
5264 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5265 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5266 provided for each customer.
5267
5268 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5269 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5270 unobvious parameters.
5271
5272 Example:
5273 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5274 backend private_monitoring
5275 stats enable
5276 stats show-node Europe-1
5277 stats uri /admin?stats
5278 stats refresh 5s
5279
5280 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5281 section.
5282
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005283
5284stats uri <prefix>
5285 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5287 yes | no | yes | yes
5288 Arguments :
5289 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5290 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5291 query string.
5292
5293 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5294 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5295 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5296 possible to reach it in the application.
5297
5298 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005299 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005300 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5301 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5302 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5303 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5304
5305 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5306 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5307 an address or a port to statistics only.
5308
5309 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5310 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5311 unobvious parameters.
5312
5313 Example :
5314 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5315 backend public_www
5316 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5317 stats enable
5318 stats hide-version
5319 stats scope .
5320 stats uri /admin?stats
5321 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5322 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5323 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5324
5325 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5326 backend private_monitoring
5327 stats enable
5328 stats uri /admin?stats
5329 stats refresh 5s
5330
5331 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5332
5333
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005334stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5335 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005337 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005338
5339 Arguments :
5340 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5341 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5342 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5343 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5344
5345 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5346 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5347 the "stick-table" statement.
5348
5349 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5350 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5351 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5352 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5353 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5354
5355 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5356 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5357 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5358 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5359 transformation rules.
5360
5361 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5362 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5363 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5364 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5365 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5366 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5367 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5368
5369 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5370 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5371 ACL based conditions.
5372
5373 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5374 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5375 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5376 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5377
5378 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5379 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5380 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5381 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5382
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005383 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5384 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5385 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5386
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005387 Example :
5388 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5389 # last 30 minutes
5390 backend pop
5391 mode tcp
5392 balance roundrobin
5393 stick store-request src
5394 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5395 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5396 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5397
5398 backend smtp
5399 mode tcp
5400 balance roundrobin
5401 stick match src table pop
5402 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5403 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5404
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005405 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5406 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005407
5408
5409stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5410 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5412 no | no | yes | yes
5413
5414 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5415 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5416 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5417 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5418
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005419 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5420 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5421 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5422
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005423 Examples :
5424 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005425 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005426
5427 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5428 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5429 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5430
5431
5432 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5433 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5434 backend http
5435 mode http
5436 balance roundrobin
5437 stick on src table https
5438 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5439 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5440 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5441
5442 backend https
5443 mode tcp
5444 balance roundrobin
5445 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5446 stick on src
5447 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5448 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5449
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005450 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005451
5452
5453stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5454 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5456 no | no | yes | yes
5457
5458 Arguments :
5459 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5460 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5461 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5462 server is selected.
5463
5464 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5465 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5466 the "stick-table" statement.
5467
5468 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5469 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5470 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5471 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5472 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5473 address.
5474
5475 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5476 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5477 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5478 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5479 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5480 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5481 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5482 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5483 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5484 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5485
5486 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5487 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5488 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5489 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5490 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5491 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5492 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5493
5494 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5495 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5496 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5497 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5498
5499 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5500 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5501 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5502 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5503 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5504 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5505 another protocol or access method.
5506
5507 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5508 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5509 the request.
5510
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005511 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5512 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5513 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5514
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005515 Example :
5516 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5517 # last 30 minutes
5518 backend pop
5519 mode tcp
5520 balance roundrobin
5521 stick store-request src
5522 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5523 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5524 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5525
5526 backend smtp
5527 mode tcp
5528 balance roundrobin
5529 stick match src table pop
5530 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5531 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5532
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005533 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5534 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005535
5536
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005537stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005538 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5539 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005540 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005542 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005543
5544 Arguments :
5545 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5546 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5547 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5548 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5549
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005550 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5551 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5552 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5553 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5554
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005555 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5556 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5557 instance.
5558
5559 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5560 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5561 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5562 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5563 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5564 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005565 to 32 characters.
5566
5567 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5568 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5569 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5570 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5571 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5572 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005573
5574 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005575 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5576 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005577 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5578 increase.
5579
5580 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005581 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5582 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5583 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005584
5585 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5586 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5587 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5588 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5589 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5590 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5591 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5592 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5593 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5594 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5595 parameter (see below).
5596
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005597 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5598 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5599 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5600 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5601 soft restart.
5602
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005603 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5604
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005605 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5606 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5607 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5608 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5609 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5610 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5611 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5612 if not expiration delay is specified.
5613
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005614 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5615 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5616 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5617 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005618 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5619 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5620 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5621 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5622 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5623 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5624 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5625 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5626 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5627 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5628 types and their arguments.
5629
5630 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5631 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5632 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5633 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5634
5635 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5636 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5637 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5638 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5639
5640 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5641 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5642 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5643 they were received.
5644
5645 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5646 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5647 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5648 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5649 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5650
5651 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5652 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5653 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5654 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5655 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5656
5657 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5658 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5659 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5660
5661 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5662 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5663 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5664 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5665 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5666
5667 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5668 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5669 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5670 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5671 the client side.
5672
5673 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5674 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5675 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5676 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5677 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5678 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5679 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5680
5681 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5682 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5683 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5684 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5685 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5686 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5687 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5688
5689 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5690 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5691 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5692 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5693 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5694 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5695
5696 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5697 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5698 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5699 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5700
5701 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5702 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5703 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5704 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5705 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5706 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5707 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5708 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5709 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5710 recommended for better fairness.
5711
5712 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5713 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5714 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5715 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5716
5717 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5718 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5719 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5720 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5721 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5722 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5723 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5724 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5725 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5726 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005727
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005728 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5729 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005730 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5731 reference it.
5732
5733 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5734 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5735 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5736 as an exclusive stickiness.
5737
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005738 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5739 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5740 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5741 something that can be ignored.
5742
5743 Example:
5744 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5745 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5746 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5747 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5748
5749 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005750 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005751
5752
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005753stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5754 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 no | no | yes | yes
5757
5758 Arguments :
5759 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5760 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5761 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5762 server is selected.
5763
5764 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5765 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5766 the "stick-table" statement.
5767
5768 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5769 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5770 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5771 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5772
5773 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5774 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5775 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5776 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5777 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5778 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5779 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5780 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5781 rules.
5782
5783 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5784 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5785 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5786 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5787 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5788 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5789 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5790
5791 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5792 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5793 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5794 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5795
5796 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5797 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5798 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5799 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5800 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5801 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5802 another protocol or access method.
5803
5804 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5805
5806 Example :
5807 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5808 backend https
5809 mode tcp
5810 balance roundrobin
5811 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5812 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5813
5814 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5815 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5816
5817 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5818 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5819 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5820
5821 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5822 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5823
5824 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5825 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5826 # at offset 44.
5827
5828 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5829 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5830
5831 # Learn on response if server hello.
5832 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5833
5834 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5835 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5836
5837 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5838 extraction.
5839
5840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005841tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5842 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5844 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005845 Arguments :
5846 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5847 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5848 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005849
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005850 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005851
5852 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5853 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005854 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5855 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5856 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5857 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5858 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5859 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005860
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005861 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5862 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5863 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5864 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005865
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005866 Three types of actions are supported :
5867 - accept :
5868 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5869 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5870 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005871
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005872 - reject :
5873 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5874 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5875 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5876 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5877 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5878 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5879 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5880 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5881 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5882 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5883 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5884 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005885
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005886 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5887 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5888 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5889 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5890 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5891 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5892 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5893 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5894 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005896 These actions take one or two arguments :
5897 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5898 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5899 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005900
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005901 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5902 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5903 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5904 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005905
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005906 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5907 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5908 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5909 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5910 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5911 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5912 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5913 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5914 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5915 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005916
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005917 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5918 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5919 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005920
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005921 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5922 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5923 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005925 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005926 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005927 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005928
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005929 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5930 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5931 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005932
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005933 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5934 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5935 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005936
5937 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5938
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005939 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005940
5941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005942tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5943 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005945 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005946 Arguments :
5947 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5948 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5949 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005950
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005951 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005953 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5954 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5955 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5956 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5957 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005958
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005959 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5960 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5961 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5962 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5963 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5964 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5965 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5966 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5967 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005969 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5970 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5971 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5972 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005974 Three types of actions are supported :
5975 - accept :
5976 - reject :
5977 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005978
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005979 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5980 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005982 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5983 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5984 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5985 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5986 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5987 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005989 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005990 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5991 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005993 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5994 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5995 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5996 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5997 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005998
5999 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006000 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6001 # and reject everything else.
6002 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6003 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6004 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6005 tcp-request content reject
6006
6007 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006008 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6009 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6010 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006011 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006012
6013 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6014 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6015 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006016 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006017 tcp-request content reject
6018
6019 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6020 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6021
6022 frontend http
6023 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6024 # protecting all our sites
6025 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6026 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6027 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6028 ...
6029 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6030
6031 backend http_dynamic
6032 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6033 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6034 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6035 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6036 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6037 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6038 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006040 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006042 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006043
6044
6045tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6046 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006048 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006049 Arguments :
6050 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6051 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6052 as explained at the top of this document.
6053
6054 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6055 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6056 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6057 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6058 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6059
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006060 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6061 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6062 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6063 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6064
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006065 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6066 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006067 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006068 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006069 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6070 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6071 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6072 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006073
6074 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6075 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6076 it pass through unaffected.
6077
6078 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6079 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6080 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006081 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006082 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6083 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006084 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6085 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6086 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006087
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006088 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006089 "timeout client".
6090
6091
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006092tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6093 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 no | no | yes | yes
6096 Arguments :
6097 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6098 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6099 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6100
6101 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6102
6103 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6104 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6105 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6106 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6107 set and expires with no matching rule.
6108
6109 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6110
6111 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6112 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6113 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6114 inserted.
6115
6116 Two types of actions are supported :
6117 - accept :
6118 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6119 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6120 the rules evaluation.
6121
6122 - reject :
6123 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6124 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6125 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6126
6127 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6128 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6129 for changing the default action to a reject.
6130
6131 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6132 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6133 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6134 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6135 period.
6136
6137 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6138
6139 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6140
6141
6142tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6143 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6145 no | no | yes | yes
6146 Arguments :
6147 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6148 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6149 as explained at the top of this document.
6150
6151 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6152
6153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006154timeout check <timeout>
6155 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6156 established.
6157
6158 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6159 yes | no | yes | yes
6160 Arguments:
6161 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6162 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6163 as explained at the top of this document.
6164
6165 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6166 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6167 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6168 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006169 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6170 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6171 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006172
6173 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6174 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6175
6176 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6177 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006178 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006179
6180 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6181 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6182 forget about it.
6183
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006184 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6185 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006186
6187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006188timeout client <timeout>
6189timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6190 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6192 yes | yes | yes | no
6193 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006194 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006195 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6196 as explained at the top of this document.
6197
6198 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6199 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6200 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6201 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6202 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6203 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6204 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6205 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006206 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006207 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6208 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6209
6210 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6211 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6212 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6213 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6214 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6215 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6216
6217 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6218 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6219 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6220
6221 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6222
6223
6224timeout connect <timeout>
6225timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6226 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | no | yes | yes
6229 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6232 as explained at the top of this document.
6233
6234 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006235 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006236 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006237 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006238 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6239 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006240
6241 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6242 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6243 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6244 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6245 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6246 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6247
6248 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6249 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6250 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6251
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006252 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6253 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006254
6255
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006256timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6257 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 yes | yes | yes | yes
6260 Arguments :
6261 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6262 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6263 as explained at the top of this document.
6264
6265 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6266 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6267 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6268 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6269 once the request has started to present itself.
6270
6271 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6272 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6273 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6274 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6275 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6276
6277 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6278 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6279 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6280 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6281
6282 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6283 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6284 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6285 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6286 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006287 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006288
6289 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6290 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6291 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6292 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6293
6294 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6295
6296
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006297timeout http-request <timeout>
6298 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006300 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006301 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006302 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006303 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6304 as explained at the top of this document.
6305
6306 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6307 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6308 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6309 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6310 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6311 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6312 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6313 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6314
6315 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6316 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006317 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6318 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006319
6320 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6321 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6322 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6323 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6324 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6325
6326 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006327 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6328 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6329 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006330
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006331 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006332
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006333
6334timeout queue <timeout>
6335 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6337 yes | no | yes | yes
6338 Arguments :
6339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6341 as explained at the top of this document.
6342
6343 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6344 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6345 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6346 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6347 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6348
6349 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6350 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6351 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6352 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6353
6354 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6355
6356
6357timeout server <timeout>
6358timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6359 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6361 yes | no | yes | yes
6362 Arguments :
6363 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6364 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6365 as explained at the top of this document.
6366
6367 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6368 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6369 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6370 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6371 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6372 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6373 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6374
6375 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6376 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6377 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6378 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6379 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006380 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006381 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006382 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006383
6384 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6385 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6386 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6387 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6388 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6389 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6390
6391 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6392 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6393 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6394
6395 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6396
6397
6398timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006399 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6401 yes | yes | yes | yes
6402 Arguments :
6403 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6405 as explained at the top of this document.
6406
6407 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6408 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6409 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6410
6411 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6412 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6413 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6414 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006415 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006416
6417 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6418
6419
6420transparent (deprecated)
6421 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006423 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006424 Arguments : none
6425
6426 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6427 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6428 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6429 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6430 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6431 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6432 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6433 appropriate server.
6434
6435 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6436
6437 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6438 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6439
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006440 See also: "option transparent"
6441
6442
6443use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6444use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006445 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 no | yes | yes | no
6448 Arguments :
6449 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006451 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006452
6453 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6454 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6455 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006456 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6457 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6458 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6459 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006460
6461 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6462 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6463 assign the backend.
6464
6465 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6466 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6467 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6468 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6469 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6470 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6471
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006472 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006473 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006474 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6475 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6476 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6477
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006478 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006479
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010064815. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006482------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006484The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6485which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6486arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6487settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6488after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6489Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6490address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006492 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006493 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006495The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006497addr <ipv4>
6498 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6499 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6500 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6501 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6502 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006504 Supported in default-server: No
6505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006506backup
6507 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6508 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6509 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6510 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6511 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6512 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006514 Supported in default-server: No
6515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006516check
6517 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6518 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6519 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6520 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6521 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6522 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6523 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6524 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6525 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01006526 "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to
6527 those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006529 Supported in default-server: No
6530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006531cookie <value>
6532 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6533 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6534 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6535 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6536 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6537 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6538 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006540 Supported in default-server: No
6541
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006542disabled
6543 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6544 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6545 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6546 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6547 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6548
6549 Supported in default-server: No
6550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006551error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006552 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6553 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6554 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006556 Supported in default-server: Yes
6557
6558 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006560fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006561 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6562 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6563 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6564
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006565 Supported in default-server: Yes
6566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006567id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006568 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6569 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6570 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006572 Supported in default-server: No
6573
6574inter <delay>
6575fastinter <delay>
6576downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006577 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6578 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6579 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6580 between checks depending on the server state :
6581
6582 Server state | Interval used
6583 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6584 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6585 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6586 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6587 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6588 or yet unchecked. |
6589 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6590 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6591 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006593 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6594 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6595 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6596 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6597 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6598 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6599 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6600 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6601 servers.
6602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006603 Supported in default-server: Yes
6604
6605maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006606 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6607 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6608 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6609 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6610 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6611 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6612 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6613 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006615 Supported in default-server: Yes
6616
6617maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006618 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6619 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6620 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6621 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6622 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6623 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6624 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006626 Supported in default-server: Yes
6627
6628minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006629 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6630 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6631 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6632 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6633 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6634 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006635 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006636 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006638 Supported in default-server: Yes
6639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006640observe <mode>
6641 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6642 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6643 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6644 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6645 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6646 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6647 headers, a timeout, etc.
6648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006649 Supported in default-server: No
6650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006651 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006653on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006654 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6655 Currently, four modes are available:
6656 - fastinter: force fastinter
6657 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6658 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6659 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6660 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006662 Supported in default-server: Yes
6663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006664 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006666port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006667 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6668 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6669 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6670 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6671 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6672 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006674 Supported in default-server: Yes
6675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006676redir <prefix>
6677 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6678 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6679 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6680 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6681 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6682 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6683 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6684 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006685 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006686 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6687 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6688 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6689 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6690 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6691
6692 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006694 Supported in default-server: No
6695
6696rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006697 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6698 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6699 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006701 Supported in default-server: Yes
6702
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006703send-proxy
6704 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6705 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6706 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6707 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6708 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6709 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6710 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6711 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6712 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6713 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6714 option of the "bind" keyword.
6715
6716 Supported in default-server: No
6717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006718slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006719 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6720 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6721 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6722 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6723 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6724 parameters :
6725
6726 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6727 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6728
6729 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6730 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6731 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6732 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6733
6734 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6735 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6736 seen as failed.
6737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006738 Supported in default-server: Yes
6739
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006740source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006741source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006742source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006743 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6744 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6745 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6746 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6747
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006748 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6749 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6750 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6751 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6752 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6753 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6754 server.
6755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006756 Supported in default-server: No
6757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006758track [<proxy>/]<server>
6759 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6760 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6761 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6762 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6763 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006765 Supported in default-server: No
6766
6767weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006768 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6769 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6770 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006771 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6772 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6773 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6774 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6775 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6776 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006778 Supported in default-server: Yes
6779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006780
67816. HTTP header manipulation
6782---------------------------
6783
6784In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6785response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6786request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6787which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6788against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6789to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6790passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6791headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6792never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6793
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006794There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6795(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6796rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6797messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6798in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006799happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006800add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6801normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006803This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6804in section 4.2 :
6805
6806 - reqadd <string>
6807 - reqallow <search>
6808 - reqiallow <search>
6809 - reqdel <search>
6810 - reqidel <search>
6811 - reqdeny <search>
6812 - reqideny <search>
6813 - reqpass <search>
6814 - reqipass <search>
6815 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6816 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6817 - reqtarpit <search>
6818 - reqitarpit <search>
6819 - rspadd <string>
6820 - rspdel <search>
6821 - rspidel <search>
6822 - rspdeny <search>
6823 - rspideny <search>
6824 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6825 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6826
6827With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6828is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6829parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6830prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6831Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6832
6833 \t for a tab
6834 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6835 \n for a new line (LF)
6836 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6837 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6838 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6839 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6840 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6841
6842The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6843portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6844above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6845regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
68469 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6847is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6848
6849The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6850after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6851
6852Notes related to these keywords :
6853---------------------------------
6854 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6855 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6856 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6857
6858 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6859 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6860 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6861
6862 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6863 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6864 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6865 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6866 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6867
6868 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6869 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6870 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6871 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6872 useless headers before adding new ones.
6873
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006874 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006875 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6876
6877 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6878 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6879 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6880
6881 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6882 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006883 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006884
6885
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010068867. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6887------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006888
6889The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6890content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6891from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6892simple :
6893
6894 - define test criteria with sets of values
6895 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6896
6897The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6898
6899In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6900
6901 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6902
6903This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6904Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6905and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6906an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6907of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6908
6909ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6910'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6911which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6912
6913There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6914performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6915
6916The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6917
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006918 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6919 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006920 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6921
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006922The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6923specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6924possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006925multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6926be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6927needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6928space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6929match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6930lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6931duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6932to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6933instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006934
6935 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6936
6937In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6938the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6939case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6940too.
6941
6942Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6943a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6944ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6945
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006946Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006947
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006948 - integers or integer ranges
6949 - strings
6950 - regular expressions
6951 - IP addresses and networks
6952
6953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069547.1. Matching integers
6955----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006956
6957Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6958that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6959expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6960may be omitted.
6961
6962For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6963unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6964representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6965
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006966As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6967two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6968instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6969ranges and operators.
6970
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006971For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006972operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6973Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6974of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006976Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006977
6978 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6979 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6980 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6981 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6982 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006984For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006985
6986 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6987
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006988This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6989
6990 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069937.2. Matching strings
6994---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006995
6996String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6997exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6998characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6999string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7000to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007001before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007002
7003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070047.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7005-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007006
7007Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7008they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7009possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7010passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7011the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007012the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7013match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007014
7015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070167.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7017----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007018
7019IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7020netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7021within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007022host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007023difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7024at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7025does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7026parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007027
7028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070297.5. Available matching criteria
7030--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070327.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7033------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007034
7035A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7036analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7037addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7038
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007039always_false
7040 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7041 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7042
7043always_true
7044 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7045 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7046
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007047avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02007048avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007049 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7050 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7051 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7052 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7053 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7054 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7055 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7056 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7057 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7058 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7059 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007060
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007061be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02007062be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007063 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7064 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7065 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7066 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7067 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007068
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007069be_id <integer>
7070 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7071 backend it was called.
7072
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007073be_sess_rate <integer>
7074be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
7075 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7076 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7077 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7078 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7079 sucking of an online dictionary).
7080
7081 Example :
7082 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7083 backend dynamic
7084 mode http
7085 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7086 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007087
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007088connslots <integer>
7089connslots(backend) <integer>
7090 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007091 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007092 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7093
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007094 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7095 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007096
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007097 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007098 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7099 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7100 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7101 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7102 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007103 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007104
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007105 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7106 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7107 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7108 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007109
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007110dst <ip_address>
7111 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7112 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007114dst_conn <integer>
7115 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7116 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7117 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7118 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7119 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7120 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7121
7122dst_port <integer>
7123 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7124 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7125
7126fe_conn <integer>
7127fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7128 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7129 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7130 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7131 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7132 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7133 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7134 criteria.
7135
7136fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007137 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007138 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007139
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007140fe_sess_rate <integer>
7141fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7142 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7143 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7144 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7145 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7146 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7147 the rate to go down below the limit.
7148
7149 Example :
7150 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7151 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7152 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7153 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7154 frontend mail
7155 bind :25
7156 mode tcp
7157 maxconn 100
7158 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7159 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7160 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7161 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007162
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007163nbsrv <integer>
7164nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7165 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7166 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7167 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7168 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7169 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007170
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007171queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007172queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007173 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7174 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7175 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7176 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7177 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7178 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7179 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007181sc1_bytes_in_rate
7182sc2_bytes_in_rate
7183 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7184 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7185 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7186
7187sc1_bytes_out_rate
7188sc2_bytes_out_rate
7189 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7190 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7191 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7192
7193sc1_conn_cnt
7194sc2_conn_cnt
7195 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7196 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7197
7198sc1_conn_cur
7199sc2_conn_cur
7200 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7201 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7202 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7203
7204sc1_conn_rate
7205sc2_conn_rate
7206 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7207 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7208 See also src_conn_rate.
7209
7210sc1_get_gpc0
7211sc2_get_gpc0
7212 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7213 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7214
7215sc1_http_err_cnt
7216sc2_http_err_cnt
7217 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7218 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7219 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7220
7221sc1_http_err_rate
7222sc2_http_err_rate
7223 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7224 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7225 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7226 src_http_err_rate.
7227
7228sc1_http_req_cnt
7229sc2_http_req_cnt
7230 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7231 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7232 src_http_req_cnt.
7233
7234sc1_http_req_rate
7235sc2_http_req_rate
7236 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7237 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7238 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7239 src_http_req_rate.
7240
7241sc1_inc_gpc0
7242sc2_inc_gpc0
7243 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7244 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7245 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7246 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7247 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7248 when a first ACL was verified :
7249
7250 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7251 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7252 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7253
7254sc1_kbytes_in
7255sc2_kbytes_in
7256 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7257 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7258 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7259 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7260
7261sc1_kbytes_out
7262sc2_kbytes_out
7263 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7264 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7265 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7266 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7267
7268sc1_sess_cnt
7269sc2_sess_cnt
7270 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7271 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7272 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7273 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7274 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7275 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7276
7277sc1_sess_rate
7278sc2_sess_rate
7279 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7280 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7281 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7282 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7283 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7284 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7285
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007286so_id <integer>
7287 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7288
7289src <ip_address>
7290 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7291 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7292 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7293
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007294src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7295src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7296 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7297 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7298 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007299 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007300
7301src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7302src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7303 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7304 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7305 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007306 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007307
7308src_conn_cnt <integer>
7309src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7310 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7311 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7312 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007313 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007314
7315src_conn_cur <integer>
7316src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7317 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7318 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7319 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007320 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007321
7322src_conn_rate <integer>
7323src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7324 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7325 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7326 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007327 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007328
7329src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7330src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7331 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7332 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7333 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007334 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007335
7336src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7337src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7338 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7339 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7340 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007341 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007342
7343src_http_err_rate <integer>
7344src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7345 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7346 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7347 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7348 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007349 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007350
7351src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7352src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7353 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7354 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7355 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007356 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007357
7358src_http_req_rate <integer>
7359src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7360 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7361 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7362 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7363 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007364 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007365
7366src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7367src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7368 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7369 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7370 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7371 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7372 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7373 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7374
7375 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7376 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007377 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007378
7379src_kbytes_in <integer>
7380src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7381 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7382 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7383 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7384 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007385 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007386
7387src_kbytes_out <integer>
7388src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7389 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7390 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7391 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7392 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007393 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007394
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007395src_port <integer>
7396 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007397
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007398src_sess_cnt <integer>
7399src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7400 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7401 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7402 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7403 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007404 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007405
7406src_sess_rate <integer>
7407src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7408 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7409 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7410 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7411 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007412 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007413
7414src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7415src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007416 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007417 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7418 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007419 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7420 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7421 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007422 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007423
7424 Example :
7425 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7426 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7427 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7428 listen ssh
7429 bind :22
7430 mode tcp
7431 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007432 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007433 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7434 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7435
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007436srv_id <integer>
7437 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7438
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007439srv_is_up(<server>)
7440srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7441 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7442 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7443 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7444 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7445 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7446 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7447 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7448 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7449
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007450table_avl <integer>
7451table_avl(table) <integer>
7452 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7453 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7454
7455table_cnt <integer>
7456table_cnt(table) <integer>
7457 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7458 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7459 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007461
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020074627.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7463---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007464
7465A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7466during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007467through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7468keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007469
7470req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007471 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007472 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7473 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7474 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7475 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7476 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7477 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7478
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007479req_proto_http
7480 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7481 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007482 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007483 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7484 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7485
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007486req_rdp_cookie <string>
7487req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7488 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7489 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7490 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7491 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7492 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7493 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7494 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7495 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7496
7497req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7498req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7499 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7500 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7501 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7502 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7503 cookies.
7504
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007505req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7506 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7507 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7508 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7509 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7510 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7511 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7512 with TCP request content inspection.
7513
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007514req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7515 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7516 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7517 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7518 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7519
7520rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7521 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7522 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7523 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7524 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7525
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007526wait_end
7527 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7528 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7529 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7530 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7531 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7532 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7533 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7534 inspection.
7535
7536 Examples :
7537 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7538 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7539 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7540
7541 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7542 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7543 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7544 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7545 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7546 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7547 tcp-request content reject
7548
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075507.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7551--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007552
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007553A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007554application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7555read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7556than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7557
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007558hdr <string>
7559hdr(header) <string>
7560 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7561 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7562 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7563 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7564 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7565
7566 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7567 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7568 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7569
7570 hdr(Connection) -i close
7571
7572hdr_beg <string>
7573hdr_beg(header) <string>
7574 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7575 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7576 response headers sent by the server.
7577
7578hdr_cnt <integer>
7579hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7580 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7581 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7582 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7583 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7584 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7585 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7586 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7587
7588hdr_dir <string>
7589hdr_dir(header) <string>
7590 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7591 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7592 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7593 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7594 headers sent by the server.
7595
7596hdr_dom <string>
7597hdr_dom(header) <string>
7598 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7599 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7600 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7601 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7602 server.
7603
7604hdr_end <string>
7605hdr_end(header) <string>
7606 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7607 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7608 response headers sent by the server.
7609
7610hdr_ip <ip_address>
7611hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7612 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7613 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7614 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7615 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7616
7617hdr_reg <regex>
7618hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7619 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7620 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7621 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7622 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7623 response headers sent by the server.
7624
7625hdr_sub <string>
7626hdr_sub(header) <string>
7627 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7628 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7629 response headers sent by the server.
7630
7631hdr_val <integer>
7632hdr_val(header) <integer>
7633 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7634 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7635 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7636 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7637
7638http_auth(userlist)
7639http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7640 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7641 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7642 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7643 of specified groups.
7644
7645 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7646
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007647http_req_first
7648 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7649 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7650 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7651 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7652
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007653method <string>
7654 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7655 already check for most common methods.
7656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007657path <string>
7658 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7659 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7660 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7661
7662path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007663 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7664 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007665
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007666path_dir <string>
7667 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7668 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7669 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7670 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7671
7672path_dom <string>
7673 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7674 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7675 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7676
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007677path_end <string>
7678 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7679 control file name extension.
7680
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007681path_reg <regex>
7682 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7683 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7684 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7685
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007686path_sub <string>
7687 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7688 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7689 "path_dir".
7690
7691req_ver <string>
7692 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7693 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7694
7695status <integer>
7696 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7697 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7698 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007700url <string>
7701 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7702 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7703
7704url_beg <string>
7705 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7706 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7707
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007708url_dir <string>
7709 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7710 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7711 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7712 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7713
7714url_dom <string>
7715 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7716 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7717 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7718
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007719url_end <string>
7720 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7721 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007722
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007723url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007724 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7725 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007726 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007727
7728url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007729 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7730 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007731 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007732 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007733
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007734url_reg <regex>
7735 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7736 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7737 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007738
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007739url_sub <string>
7740 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7741 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007742
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077447.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7745---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007747Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7748every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007749order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007751ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7752---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007753FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007754HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007755HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7756HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007757HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7758HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7759HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7760HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7761LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007762METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7763METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7764METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7765METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7766METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7767METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007768RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007769REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007770TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007771WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7772---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007773
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077757.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7776----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007777
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007778Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7779combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007781 - AND (implicit)
7782 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7783 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007785A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007787 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007789Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7790indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007792For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7793"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7794requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7795is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007797 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7798 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7799 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7800 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007802To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7803and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007805 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7806 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7807 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7808 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007810 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7811 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7812 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7813 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007814
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007815It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7816expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7817be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7818the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7819
7820 The following rule :
7821
7822 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7823 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7824
7825 Can also be written that way :
7826
7827 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7828
7829It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7830to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7831simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7832sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7833good use is the following :
7834
7835 With named ACLs :
7836
7837 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7838 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7839 monitor fail if site_dead
7840
7841 With anonymous ACLs :
7842
7843 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007845See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007846
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007847
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010078487.8. Pattern extraction
7849-----------------------
7850
7851The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7852response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7853for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7854
7855All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7856"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7857begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7858arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7859much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7860equivalent used in ACLs.
7861
7862The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7863
7864 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007865 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7866 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7867 according to RFC 4291.
7868
7869 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
7870 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007871
7872 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7873 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7874 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007875 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7876 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7877 according to RFC 4291.
7878
7879 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
7880 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7881 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007882 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007883
7884 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7885 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7886 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7887 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7888 type integer and only works with such tables.
7889
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007890 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7891 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7892 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7893 x-forwarded-for header.
7894
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007895 payload(offset,length)
7896 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7897 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7898 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7899 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007900
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007901 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7902 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7903 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7904 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7905 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7906 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7907 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7908 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7909 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7910
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007911 url_param(name)
7912 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007913 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007914 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
7915 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
7916 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
7917
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007918The currently available list of transformations include :
7919
7920 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7921 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7922 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7923
7924 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7925 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7926 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7927
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007928 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7929 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7930 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7931 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7932 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7933
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079358. Logging
7936----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007937
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007938One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7939provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7940very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7941provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7942state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007943to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007944headers.
7945
7946In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7947about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7948send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7949
7950 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7951 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7952 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7953 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7954 at the termination.
7955
7956The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7957allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7958as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7959while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7960real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7961delay.
7962
7963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079648.1. Log levels
7965---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007966
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007967TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007968source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007969HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
7970in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
7971track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
7972syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
7973about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007974
7975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079768.2. Log formats
7977----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007978
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007979HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007980and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
7981slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
7982options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007983
7984 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7985 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7986 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7987 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7988 extents.
7989
7990 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7991 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7992 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7993 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7994 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7995
7996 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7997 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7998 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7999 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8000 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8001
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008002 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8003 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8004 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8005 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8006
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008007Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8008specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8009field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8010servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8011always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8012identifier.
8013
8014Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8015 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8016 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8017 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8018 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8019
8020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080218.2.1. Default log format
8022-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008023
8024This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8025as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8026format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8027
8028 Example :
8029 listen www
8030 mode http
8031 log global
8032 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8033
8034 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8035 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8036 (www/HTTP)
8037
8038 Field Format Extract from the example above
8039 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8040 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8041 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8042 4 'to' to
8043 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8044 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8045
8046Detailed fields description :
8047 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8048 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8049 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8050 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8051 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8052 and processed the connection.
8053 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8054
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008055In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8056"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8057connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8058
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008059It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8060will eventually disappear.
8061
8062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080638.2.2. TCP log format
8064---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008065
8066The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8067is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8068information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8069counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8070emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8071environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8072the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8073sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008074specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8075not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8076fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8077marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008078
8079 Example :
8080 frontend fnt
8081 mode tcp
8082 option tcplog
8083 log global
8084 default_backend bck
8085
8086 backend bck
8087 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8088
8089 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8090 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8091 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8092
8093 Field Format Extract from the example above
8094 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8095 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8096 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8097 4 frontend_name fnt
8098 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8099 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8100 7 bytes_read* 212
8101 8 termination_state --
8102 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8103 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8104
8105Detailed fields description :
8106 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008107 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8108 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8109 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8110 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8111 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008112
8113 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008114 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8115 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8116 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008117
8118 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8119 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8120 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8121 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8122
8123 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8124 and processed the connection.
8125
8126 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8127 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8128 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8129 applications.
8130
8131 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8132 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8133 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8134 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8135 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8136
8137 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8138 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8139 See "Timers" below for more details.
8140
8141 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8142 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8143 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8144 "Timers" below for more details.
8145
8146 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8147 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8148 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8149 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8150 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8151 details.
8152
8153 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8154 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8155 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8156 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8157 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8158
8159 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8160 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8161 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8162 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8163 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8164 for more details.
8165
8166 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8167 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8168 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8169 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8170 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008171 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008172
8173 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8174 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8175 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8176 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8177 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8178 caused by a denial of service attack.
8179
8180 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8181 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8182 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8183 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8184 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8185 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8186 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8187 denial of service attack.
8188
8189 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8190 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8191 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8192 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8193 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8194 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8195 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8196 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8197 be processed than on other servers.
8198
8199 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8200 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8201 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8202 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8203 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8204 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8205 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8206 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8207 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8208 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8209 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8210 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8211 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8212
8213 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8214 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8215 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8216 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8217 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8218 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8219 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8220 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8221
8222 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8223 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8224 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8225 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8226 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8227 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8228 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8229 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8230 occurs.
8231
8232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082338.2.3. HTTP log format
8234----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008235
8236The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8237is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8238the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8239are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8240emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8241generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8242"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8243which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008244frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8245is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008246
8247Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8248slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8249with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8250
8251 Example :
8252 frontend http-in
8253 mode http
8254 option httplog
8255 log global
8256 default_backend bck
8257
8258 backend static
8259 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8260
8261 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8262 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8263 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008264 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008265
8266 Field Format Extract from the example above
8267 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8268 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8269 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8270 4 frontend_name http-in
8271 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8272 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8273 7 status_code 200
8274 8 bytes_read* 2750
8275 9 captured_request_cookie -
8276 10 captured_response_cookie -
8277 11 termination_state ----
8278 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8279 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8280 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8281 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8282 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008283
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008284
8285Detailed fields description :
8286 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008287 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8288 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8289 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8290 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8291 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008292
8293 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008294 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8295 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8296 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008297
8298 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8299 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8300 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8301 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8302 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8303
8304 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8305 and processed the connection.
8306
8307 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8308 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8309 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8310
8311 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8312 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8313 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8314 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8315 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8316 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8317
8318 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8319 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8320 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8321 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8322 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8323 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8324
8325 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8326 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8327 See "Timers" below for more details.
8328
8329 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8330 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8331 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8332 below for more details.
8333
8334 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8335 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8336 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8337 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8338 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8339 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8340 for more details.
8341
8342 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8343 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8344 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8345 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8346 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8347 details.
8348
8349 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8350 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8351 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8352
8353 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8354 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8355 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8356 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8357 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8358 overflowing.
8359
8360 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8361 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8362 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8363 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8364 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8365 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8366 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8367 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8368
8369 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8370 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8371 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8372 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8373 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8374 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8375 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8376 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8377
8378 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8379 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8380 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8381 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8382 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8383 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8384 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8385
8386 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8387 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8388 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8389 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8390 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008391 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008392 system.
8393
8394 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8395 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8396 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8397 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8398 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8399 caused by a denial of service attack.
8400
8401 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8402 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8403 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8404 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8405 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8406 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8407 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8408 denial of service attack.
8409
8410 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8411 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8412 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8413 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8414 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8415 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8416 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8417 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8418 processed than on other servers.
8419
8420 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8421 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8422 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8423 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8424 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8425 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8426 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8427 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8428 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8429 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8430 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8431 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8432 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8433
8434 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8435 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8436 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8437 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8438 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8439 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8440 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8441 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8442
8443 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8444 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8445 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8446 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8447 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8448 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8449 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8450 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8451 occurs.
8452
8453 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8454 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8455 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8456 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8457 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8458 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8459 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8460 cookies" below for more details.
8461
8462 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8463 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8464 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8465 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8466 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8467 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8468 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8469 and cookies" below for more details.
8470
8471 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8472 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8473 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8474 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8475 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8476 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8477 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8478 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8479
8480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084818.3. Advanced logging options
8482-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008483
8484Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8485just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8486options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8487for more information about their usage.
8488
8489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084908.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8491------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008492
8493It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8494haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8495commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8496monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8497ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8498
8499 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8500 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8501 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8502 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8503
8504 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8505 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8506 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8507 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8508 such as other load-balancers.
8509
8510 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8511 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8512 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8513
8514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085158.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8516----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008517
8518The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8519what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8520or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8521"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8522just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8523log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8524after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8525is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8526with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8527with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8528
8529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085308.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8531------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008532
8533Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8534for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8535"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8536retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8537raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8538a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8539file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8540you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8541"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8542
8543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085448.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8545--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008546
8547Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8548multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8549them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8550"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8551logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8552error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8553and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8554too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8555useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8556alternative.
8557
8558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085598.4. Timing events
8560------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008561
8562Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8563reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8564the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8565frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8566mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8567
8568 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8569 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8570 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8571 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8572 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8573
8574 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8575 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8576 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8577 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8578 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8579
8580 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8581 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8582 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8583 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8584 connection never established.
8585
8586 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8587 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8588 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8589 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8590 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8591 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8592 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8593 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8594 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8595 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8596 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8597
8598 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8599 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8600 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8601 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8602 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8603
8604 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8605
8606 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8607 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8608 negative.
8609
8610These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8611protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8612that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008613due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008614close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8615session has been aborted on timeout.
8616
8617Most common cases :
8618
8619 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8620 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8621 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8622 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8623 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8624 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8625 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8626 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8627 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008628 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8629 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8630 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008631
8632 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8633 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8634 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8635 of ms on remote networks.
8636
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008637 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8638 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8639 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008640
8641 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8642 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8643 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8644 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8645 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8646 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8647 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8648 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8649 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8650 to the server until another one is released.
8651
8652Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8653
8654 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8655 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8656 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8657
8658 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8659 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8660 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8661
8662 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8663 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8664 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8665 flags.
8666
8667 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8668 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8669 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8670 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8671 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8672 the client connection was maintained open.
8673
8674 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8675 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8676 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8677 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8678
8679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086808.5. Session state at disconnection
8681-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008682
8683TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8684"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
86852-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8686each of which has a special meaning :
8687
8688 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8689 session to terminate :
8690
8691 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8692
8693 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8694 server explicitly refused it.
8695
8696 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8697 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8698 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8699 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8700 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8701 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8702
8703 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8704 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8705 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8706 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8707 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8708
8709 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8710 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8711 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8712 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8713 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8714
8715 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8716 send or receive data.
8717
8718 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8719 send or receive data.
8720
8721 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8722 with nothing left in the buffers.
8723
8724 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8725
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008726 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008727 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8728
8729 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8730 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8731 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8732 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8733 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8734
8735 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8736 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8737
8738 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8739 server (HTTP only).
8740
8741 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8742
8743 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8744 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8745 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8746
8747 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8748 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8749 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8750
8751 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8752
8753 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8754 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8755
8756 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8757 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8758 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8759
8760 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8761 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008762 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8763 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008764
8765 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8766 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8767 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8768 another server.
8769
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008770 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008771 server.
8772
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008773 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8774 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8775 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8776 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8777
8778 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8779 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8780 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8781 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8782
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008783 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8784
8785 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8786 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8787
8788 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8789
8790 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8791 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8792 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8793
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008794 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8795 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8796 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8797 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8798 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008800 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8801
8802 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8803 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8804
8805 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8806
8807 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8808
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008809The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8810was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008811helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8812starvation, attacks, etc...
8813
8814The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8815alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8816easier finding and understanding.
8817
8818 Flags Reason
8819
8820 -- Normal termination.
8821
8822 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8823 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8824 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8825 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8826
8827 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8828 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8829 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8830 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8831 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8832 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008834 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8835 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8836 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8837
8838 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8839 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8840 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8841
8842 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8843 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8844 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8845 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8846 the server takes too long to respond.
8847
8848 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8849 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8850 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8851 long a time to respond.
8852
8853 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8854 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8855 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8856 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8857 and the client.
8858
8859 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8860 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8861 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8862 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8863 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8864 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8865
8866 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8867 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008868 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8869 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8870 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8871 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008873 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008874 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8875 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8876 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8877 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8878 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8879
8880 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8881 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8882 503 or 504 here.
8883
8884 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8885 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8886 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8887 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8888 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8889
8890 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8891 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008892 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008893 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8894 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8895
8896 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8897 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8898 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8899 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8900 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8901 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8902 between haproxy and the server.
8903
8904 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8905 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8906 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8907 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8908 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8909 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8910 solution is to fix the application.
8911
8912 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8913 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8914 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8915 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8916 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8917 external attacks.
8918
8919 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8920 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8921 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8922 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8923 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8924
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008925 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
8926 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
8927 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
8928 the client.
8929
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008930 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8931 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8932 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8933 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008934 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
8935 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
8936 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
8937 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
8938 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008939
8940 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8941 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8942 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8943 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8944
8945 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8946 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8947 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8948 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8949
8950 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8951 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8952 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8953 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8954
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008955The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8956persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8957important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8958re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8959
8960 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8961
8962 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8963 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8964 set on a GET request.
8965
8966 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8967 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8968 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8969 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8970
8971 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8972 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8973 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8974
8975 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8976 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8977 already got a cookie.
8978
8979 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8980 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8981 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8982 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8983 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8984
8985 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8986 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8987 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8988
8989 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8990 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8991 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8992
8993 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8994 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8995
8996 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8997 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8998 then advertised in the response.
8999
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090018.6. Non-printable characters
9002-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009003
9004In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9005consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9006converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9007prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9008being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9009escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9010is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9011'}' when logging headers.
9012
9013Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9014issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9015containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9016
9017Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9018the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9019performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9020
9021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090228.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9023---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009024
9025Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9026achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009027section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009028cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9029the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9030the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009031locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009032not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9033user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9034a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9035wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9036
9037 Examples :
9038 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9039 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9040
9041 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9042 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9043
9044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090458.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9046---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009047
9048Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9049proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9050the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9051server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9052
9053Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9054response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009055section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009056
9057It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009058time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9059appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009060are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9061and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9062follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9063request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9064in the logs.
9065
9066 Example :
9067 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9068 listen proxy-out
9069 mode http
9070 option httplog
9071 option logasap
9072 log global
9073 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9074
9075 # log the name of the virtual server
9076 capture request header Host len 20
9077
9078 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9079 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9080
9081 # log the beginning of the referrer
9082 capture request header Referer len 20
9083
9084 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9085 capture response header Server len 20
9086
9087 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9088 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9089
9090 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9091 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9092
9093 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9094 capture response header Via len 20
9095
9096 # log the URL location during a redirection
9097 capture response header Location len 20
9098
9099 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9100 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9101 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9102 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9103 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9104
9105 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9106 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9107 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9108 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009109 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009110
9111 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9112 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9113 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9114 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9115 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009116 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009117
9118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091198.9. Examples of logs
9120---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009121
9122These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9123them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9124reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9125
9126 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9127 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9128 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9129
9130 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9131 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9132
9133 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9134 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9135 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9136
9137 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9138 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9139
9140 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9141 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9142 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9143
9144 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009145 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009146 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9147 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9148
9149 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9150 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9151 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9152
9153 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9154 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9155 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9156 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9157 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9158 to return the 502 and not the server.
9159
9160 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009161 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009162
9163 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9164 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9165 Nothing was sent to any server.
9166
9167 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9168 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9169
9170 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9171 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9172 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9173 send a 408 return code to the client.
9174
9175 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9176 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9177
9178 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9179 5 seconds ("c----").
9180
9181 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9182 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009183 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009184
9185 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009186 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009187 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9188 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9189 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9190 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9191 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009192
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091949. Statistics and monitoring
9195----------------------------
9196
9197It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9198mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9199CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9200Unix socket.
9201
9202
92039.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009204---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009205
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009206The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9207page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009209 0. pxname: proxy name
9210 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9211 for server)
9212 2. qcur: current queued requests
9213 3. qmax: max queued requests
9214 4. scur: current sessions
9215 5. smax: max sessions
9216 6. slim: sessions limit
9217 7. stot: total sessions
9218 8. bin: bytes in
9219 9. bout: bytes out
9220 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009221 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009222 12. ereq: request errors
9223 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009224 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009225 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9226 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009227 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009228 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9229 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9230 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9231 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9232 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9233 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9234 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9235 25. qlimit: queue limit
9236 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9237 27. iid: unique proxy id
9238 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9239 29. throttle: warm up status
9240 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9241 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009242 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009243 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9244 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9245 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009246 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009247 UNK -> unknown
9248 INI -> initializing
9249 SOCKERR -> socket error
9250 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9251 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9252 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9253 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9254 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9255 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9256 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9257 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9258 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9259 disable-on-404
9260 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9261 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9262 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009263 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9264 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009265 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9266 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9267 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9268 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9269 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9270 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009271 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9272 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9273 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9274 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009275 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9276 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009277
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092799.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009280-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009281
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009282The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009283must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9284is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9285a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9286risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9287followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9288given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9289then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9290to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009291
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009292It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9293on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9294own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009295
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009296clear counters
9297 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9298 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9299 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9300 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9301 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9302
9303clear counters all
9304 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9305 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9306 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9307
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009308clear table <table> key <key>
9309 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
9310 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
9311 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
9312 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
9313 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
9314 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
9315 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
9316 usuall enough.
9317
9318 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009319 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009320 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009321 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9322 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9323 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9324 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009325
9326 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9327
9328 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009329 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009330 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9331 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009332
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009333disable server <backend>/<server>
9334 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9335 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9336 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9337 during the maintenance.
9338
9339 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9340 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9341
9342 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9343 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9344
9345 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9346 level "admin".
9347
9348enable server <backend>/<server>
9349 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9350 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9351
9352 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9353 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9354
9355 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9356 level "admin".
9357
9358get weight <backend>/<server>
9359 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9360 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9361 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9362 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9363 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9364 dash ('#').
9365
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009366help
9367 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9368 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009369
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009370prompt
9371 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9372 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9373 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9374 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9375 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9376 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9377 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9378 command.
9379
9380quit
9381 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009382
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009383set timeout cli <delay>
9384 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9385 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9386 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9387
9388set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9389 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9390 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9391 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9392 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9393 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9394 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9395 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9396 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9397 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9398 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9399 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9400 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9401 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9402 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9403
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009404show errors [<iid>]
9405 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9406 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009407 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9408 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9409 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009410
9411 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9412 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9413 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9414 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9415 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9416 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9417 are reported too.
9418
9419 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9420 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9421 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9422 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9423 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9424 code.
9425
9426 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9427 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9428 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9429 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9430 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9431 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9432 line.
9433
9434 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009435 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9436 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009437 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9438 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9439
9440 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9441 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9442 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9443 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9444 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9445 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9446 00204+ minal\r\n
9447 00211 \r\n
9448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009449 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009450 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9451 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9452 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9453 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9454 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9455 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009456
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009457show info
9458 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9459
9460show sess
9461 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009462 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9463 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9464
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009465show sess <id>
9466 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9467 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9468 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9469 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9470 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9471 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009472
9473show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9474 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9475 possible to dump only selected items :
9476 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9477 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9478 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9479 for example:
9480 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9481 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9482 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9483
9484 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009485 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9486 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009487 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9488 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9489 Nbproc: 1
9490 Process_num: 1
9491 (...)
9492
9493 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9494 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9495 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9496 (...)
9497 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9498
9499 $
9500
9501 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9502 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9503 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9504 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009505 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009506
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009507show table
9508 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9509 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9510 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9511 entries currently in use.
9512
9513 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009514 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9515 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9516 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009517
9518show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9519 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9520 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9521 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9522 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9523 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9524 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9525 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9526 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9527 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9528 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9529 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9530 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9531 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9532 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9533
9534 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009535 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9536 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9537 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9538 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9539 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9540 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009541
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009542 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9543 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9544 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9545 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009546
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009547 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9548 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9549 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9550 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9551 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009552
9553 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9554 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9555 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9556 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9557 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9558
9559 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9560 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9561 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009562 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9563 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009564 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9565 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009567/*
9568 * Local variables:
9569 * fill-column: 79
9570 * End:
9571 */